Difference between revisions of "Reference: MSEgui"

From Free Pascal wiki
Jump to navigationJump to search
 
(49 intermediate revisions by 3 users not shown)
Line 10: Line 10:
 
=== TMseFormWidget ===
 
=== TMseFormWidget ===
 
Use it in order to insert a tcustomform descendant into another widget at designtime. Does not try to load resources in "create".
 
Use it in order to insert a tcustomform descendant into another widget at designtime. Does not try to load resources in "create".
 +
<pre>
 +
        tmseform descendants ( MainForm, SimpleForm,.. )
  
=== TDockFormWidget ===
+
Client area of the form & parent of its widgets ( against which the widgets
=== TPaintbox ===
+
are placed and colored ) is presented by the "container" property
 +
not "container.frame.clientarea"
 +
 
 +
CanClose is called :
  
How to draw line (or circle) on tpaintbox? In event onpaint:
+
- on receiving "ek_close" by window
 +
- for modal window, on focus change
  
<syntaxhighlight lang=pascal>
+
- within parent window's "CanClose" where all nested windows are  
  procedure tmainfo.paintboxonpaint(const sender: twidget; const canvas: tcanvas);
+
checked for OnCloseQuery & OnClose - if any sets "mr_none" then the parent window
begin
+
can't close as well
  with sender,canvas do begin
+
  drawline(nullpoint,pointty(size),cl_yellow); 
+
- from nested window's "CanParentClose"
  //diagonal line across widget
+
- from own "CanParentClose"
  drawellipse(makerect(makepoint(bounds_cx div 2,bounds_cy div 2), size),cl_red);
 
  //circle (or ellipse) centered in widget                           
 
  end;
 
end;
 
</syntaxhighlight>
 
 
Makepoint and makerect are in msegraphutils.
 
  
=== TEventWidget ===
+
- some componnets build oneself in own "Loaded" procedure :
A widget which publishes all possible events of a twidget. Normally it is better to implement your own specialized descendant of an existing widget instead to use teventwidget.
+
= widget grids
 +
= database access components
 +
= ...
  
=== TButton ===
+
The "form.show" has parameter "transientfor".
* A rectangular clickable area that can show text/bitmap.
+
The window Z-order is above the "transientfor" window. The exact behaviour
- Main properties:
+
depends on the window manager.
Caption: read/write the text that appear on top of it.
+
       
onexecute: read/write the address of a procedure (event handler) to be executed when clicked.
+
        caption
 +
- run-time caption on the title bar
  
=== TStockGlyphButton ===
+
color
=== TRichButton ===
+
- color behind the client ( contaner ) area
=== TLabel ===
 
* Draws a piece of text on the given surface (canvas: screen/printer/bitmap).
 
- Main properties:
 
Caption: read/write the piece of text.
 
  
See also [[Reference:_MSEgui/TLabel|TLabel]]
+
container
 +
- the real parent of form's widgets, <see "tformscrollbox">
  
=== TGroupBox ===
+
cursor
=== TStepBox ===
+
- the mouse over cursor shape
=== TStringDisp ===
 
*A read only version of TStringEdit, difference from TLabel: has a frame around it.
 
-Main properties:
 
Value: read/write the text that are showed.
 
Caption: A label normally describing the purpose or meaning of the presented text, it can be positioned around the frame.
 
  
=== TByteStringDisp ===
+
enabled - "false" disables all child widgets
=== TIntegerDisp ===
 
=== TRealDisp ===
 
=== TDateTimeDisp ===
 
=== TBooleanDisp ===
 
=== TToolBar ===
 
=== TDrawGrid ===
 
=== TStringGrid ===
 
=== TTabBar ===
 
=== TTabPage ===
 
=== TTabWidget ===
 
=== TDockHandle ===
 
=== TDockPanel ===
 
=== TSpliter ===
 
  
      A widget very similar to "tspacer" but :
+
face
- designed to rearrange areas occupied by adjacent widgets
+
<see "tfacecomp"> + some more options
- a linked widget may only enlarge by "eating" the opposite one,
 
so the summary area of both widgets don't change
 
- has GUI look ( hatched grip, color etc) switched on by default
 
- facilitates run-time repositioning oneself and linked widgets
 
- linked widgets may even be other splitters, spacers (with their linked widgets ),..
 
 
        Properties:
 
  
- color
+
font
= see {any_widget.color}
+
<see "tfont">
  
- cursor
+
frame
= see {any_widget.cursor}
+
<see "tframecomp"> + some more options
 +
 +
icon
 +
<see "timage">
  
- enabled
+
mainmenu
= "false" stops user interaction
+
<see tmainmenu>
  
- face
+
name
= see {any_face}
+
- name to refer when programming
  
- frame
+
options:
= see {any_frame}
 
  
- colorgrip
+
fo_main
= color of grip hatching
+
- assigns this from as the aplication GUI-face & event receiver
 +
- causes the icon of this form to be icon of the application
  
- grip
+
fo_terminateonclose
= defines hatching pattern of the grip
+
- causes the application to terminate once the form has closed ( doesn't depend on "fo_main" )
  
* stb_dens(N) : the pattern is of rhombuses, the painted rhombs occupy "N" persents of the grip
 
  
* stb_block(N) : the pattern is of squares, painted & unpainted squares are equally sized and
+
fo_freeonclose
both have "N" pixels sides
+
- causes the form (even being modal) to release its memory on closure or OK-return from "CanClose"
 
* stb_hatchup(N) : the pattern is of right-tilted lines of 1 pixel width,
 
each "N"-th pixel forms these lines
 
  
* stb_hatchdown(N) : the pattern is of left-tilted lines of 1 pixel width,
+
fo_defaultpos
each "N"-th pixel forms these lines
+
- lets the WM to position the form initially
  
* stb_crosshatch(N) : the pattern is of crossing (left & right) tilted lines of 1 pixel width,
+
fo_screencentered
each "N"-th pixel forms these lines
+
- causes the form initially to show in center of the apllication work area
  
 +
fo_closeonesc
 +
- causes the form to close on "Esc" key pressed ( with MR_ESCAPE & "OnCloseQuery" firing )
  
- linkbottom/linkleft/linkright/linktop
+
fo_cancelonesc
= see {tspacer.*}
+
- causes the form to close on "Esc" key pressed ( with MR_CANCEL & "OnCloseQuery" firing )
  
- options
+
fo_closeonenter
 +
- causes the form to close on "Enter" key pressed ( with MR_OK & "OnCloseQuery" firing )
  
= spo_hmove
+
fo_closeonf10
* "true" allows the spliter to move horizontally
+
- causes the form to close on "F10" key pressed ( with MR_F10 & "OnCloseQuery" firing )
  
= spo_hprop
+
fo_globalshortcuts
* "true" : keep the left position proportional ( on the ratio of creation time )
+
- allows on-this-form "ao_globalshortcut" actions to trigger
to weigth of the client area of parent
 
  
= spo_hsizeprop
+
  Notes :
* "true" : keep width of the spacer proportional ( on the ratio of creation time )
+
= shortcuts for modal not "fo_localshortcut" forms are processed by app
to weigth of the client area of parent
+
= shortcuts for "fo_globalshorcut" forms are processed by the owning window
* the width stops shrinking on one set in design time
 
  
= spo_vmove
+
fo_localshortcuts
* "true" allows the spliter to move vertically
+
- disables triggering shortcuts of on-this-form actions
 +
 
 +
fo_autoreadstat
 +
- for "cs_ismodule" forms, before "OnLoaded" fires, rereads all statvars from the bound stafile/memorystream
  
= spo_vprop
+
fo_autowritestat
* "true" : keep the top position proportional ( on the ratio of creation time )
+
- in "CanClose", after "OnClose" fires [ and before app termination for "fo_terminateonlose" form ],
to height of the client area of parent
+
rewrites all statvars to the stafile/memorystream
 +
- for datamodules, does this before "OnDestroy" fires
  
= spo_vsizeprop
+
fo_savepos
* "true" : keep height of the spacer proportional ( on the ratio of creation time )
+
- saves/restores Z-order, size & scree coordinates of the form
to height of the client area of parent
+
as soon as the stat data are ready
* the height stops shrinking on one set in design time
 
  
= spo_dockleft
+
fo_savestate
* causes the "linkleft" widget to dock to the left border of splitter
+
- for top-level form, saves/restores "VSize", "Active" & "Visible"  
* make sence only if linkleft "widget.bounds_x" less than "splitter.bounds_x"
+
as soon as the stat data are ready
  
= spo_docktop
+
optionswidget
* causes the "linktop" widget to dock to the top border of splitter
+
<see "any widget">
* make sence only if linktop "widget.bounds_y" less than "splitter.bounds_y"
+
optionswindow
 +
<see "any window">
 +
popupmenu
 +
<see "tpopupmenu">
 +
stafile
 +
<see "tstafile">
 +
stavarname
 +
taborder
 +
tag
  
= spo_dockright
+
visible - for a form, only affects its childs widgets
* causes the "linkright" widget to dock to the right border of splitter
 
* make sence only if linkright "widget.(bounds_x+bounds_cx)" more than "splitter.(bounds_x+bounds_cx)"
 
  
= spo_dockbottom
+
Events:
* causes the "linkbottom" widget to dock to the bottom border of splitter
 
* make sence only if linkbottom "widget.(bounds_y+bounds_cy)" more than "splitter.(bounds_y+bounds_cy)"
 
  
!!! Two special cases :
+
activate = to set focused & redraw the invalidated area
  
1. (spo_dockleft = spo_dockright = TRUE) && (linkleft = linkright = the_same_widget) :
+
oncreate
causes the "linkleft" widget to adjust to h-positiion & width of the splitter,
+
- fires before "Loaded" procedure is called
it's even possible that the widget doesn't touch the splitter
+
- fires after creating the widget & its subwidgets but before the final arrangement
 +
- forms arent' yet visible on return
  
(spo_docktop = spo_dockbottom = TRUE) && (linktop = linkbottom = the_same_widget) :
+
  Since "Loaded" procedure hasn't yet worked at this point then
causes the "linktop" widget to adjust to v-position & height of the splitter,
+
database contents, values of widget grid's subwidgets
 +
are invalid in this event ***
  
It's even possible in these cases that the widget doesn't touch the splitter
+
onloaded
 +
- fires once "Loaded" procedure of owns & all form's widgets finishes
 +
- processed  after "OnCreate"
 +
- on finishing, forms aren't yet visible
  
- optionsscale
+
oneventloopstart ( main forms only )
= see {tscalingwidget.optionsscale}
+
- only applicable to main forms
 +
- fires once all application GUI is built and shown
 +
( and ready to user's interaction )
 +
 +
onactivate
 +
- see {any_widget.OnActivate}
  
- optionswidget
+
onenter
= see {anywidget.optionswidget}
+
= see {any_widget.OnEnter}
  
- onactivate, onchildscaled, ondeactivate, ondefocus, onenter, onexit, onfocus,
+
onfocus
  onfontheightdelta, onmove, onpopup, onresize, onshowhint
+
- see {any_widget.OnFocus}
= see "tspacer"
+
 +
 
 +
onwindowactivechanged
 +
- fires on :
 +
= touching another window even on clicking in a behind-modal window ( or its title bar )
 +
= 1-st showing the window
 +
- reactivating the window
 +
 
 +
onbeforepaint
 +
- fires at the very beginning of "paint", before drawing canvas
  
- onupdatelayout
+
onpaint
fires :
+
- fires in "paint" procedure, between drawing canvas and contained widgets
 
= on creating the splitter
 
= on any reposition of the linked widgets  
 
( due to moving the splitter, resizing the parent,.. )
 
  
=== TSpacer ===
+
onafterpaint (doafterpaint)
* a regular widget which creates a kind of positional link between surrounding widgets
+
- fires just on return from "paint" procedure
* designed to maintain distances between widgets
 
* may have GUI look, caption etc switched off by default
 
* resizing a spacer repositions its linked widgets
 
  
=== TLayouter ===
+
        onapplicationactivechanged
* a tspacer descendant designed to (auto)resize or/and move its contained widgets acc to some size/positon dependencies
+
- fires :
* may have GUI look, frame caption etc switched off by default
+
= if the application gets/looses input focus
* layouters may be nested to achieve copmplex layouts
 
  
Each layout change/assignment is divided into performing 3 consequent stages :
+
onasyncevent (doasyncevent)
 +
- fires on calling {this_form}.asyncevent(atag) from any place of the application
 +
once delivered by the app even queue
  
==== Stage 1 ====
+
"atag" set by caller(s) helps to branch within "onasyncevent", to identify the caller, etc ***
 +
generally, doesn't fire instantly because these events are delivered through the app event queue ***
  
Widgets auto resized using the following options:
 
  
<pre>
+
onchildmouseevent
- if {lao_placex OR lao_placey} :
+
- fires on any mouse activity over its child widget(s) not the (containing) widget oneself
  
= if {plo_scalesize in optionslayout}  then
+
      for forms, it even fires on enetering "container" therefore it appears as if to be the form itself ***
* widgets with "osk_nopropwith" unset in their "optionsskin" are h-scaled
 
    in the proportion of change of tlayouter's clientwidth
 
* widgets with "osk_nopropheight" unset in their "optionsskin" are v-scaled
 
    in the proportion  of change of tlayouter's clientheight
 
  
For h-resized layouter, the effect looks like :
+
onchildscaled
 +
- see {any_widget.OnChildScaled}
  
|--Widget__1---Widget__2--| => the initial look
+
onclientmouseevent
 +
- fires on any mouse activity over areas expecting user's mouse input (not titlebars/frames/...)
  
  |--Widget_1--Widget_2--| => the layouter gets narrower
+
onclose
 +
- fires in "CanClose" if "modalresult <> mr_none"
  
  |---Widget___1---Widget___2---| => the layouter gets wider
+
onclosequery
 +
- fires in "CanClose" before "OnClose"
 +
- "mr_none" set on return prevents the window (and its parent) from closing
 +
( "OnClose" is also bypassed )
  
*** both widget sizes & margins are affected ***
 
*** Widget_N may generally situate on different y-levels ***
 
 
 
otherwise :
 
  
= if lao_scalewidth in optionslayout :
+
ondeactivate
* widgets with "osk_nopropwith" unset in their "optionsskin" enters in the mode
+
- see {any_widget.OnDeactivate}
  ( not applied until the layouter resizes! ) when they are h-scaled in the proportion
+
 
  as far as clientwidth of the tlayouter changes, then stages 2 & 3 are reapplied
+
ondefocus
 +
- see {any_widget.OnDeFocus}
 +
 +
ondestroy
 +
- fires on in-code calling "BeforeDestruction"
 +
 
 +
ondestroyed
 +
- fires on return from the form's destructor ( when all resources are freed )
  
For h-resized layouter, the effect looks like :
+
onterminatequery
 +
- fires on an attempt to terminate the app
 +
- by setting "var terminate:= false", allows to cancel termination
  
  |--Single____widget????| => the initial look
+
Termination by debugger/OS facilities can't be blocked this way ( win32 )***
  
  |--Single__widget???| => the layouter gets narrower
+
onterminated
 +
- fires for not-yet-destroyed forms, once the app event loop finishes
 +
- may be caused by any closure of the main app form
 +
( app termination, WM/OS facilities, )
  
  |--Single_______widget?????| => the layouter gets wider
 
  
* also, if {lao_scaleleft in optionslayout} then left margins of the widgets
+
onwindowdestroyed
  with unset "optionsskin.osk_nopropleft" resize too otherwise retain
+
- fires once a descendant window is destroyed
 +
( for a main form, when a modal simple form is closed by any way,.. )
  
= if lao_scaleheight in optionslayout :
+
onevent
* widgets with "osk_nopropheight" unset in their "optionsskin" enters in the mode
+
- fires on receiving an event
  ( not applied until the layouter resizes! ) when they are v-scaled in the proportion
+
= for simple forms, it's only "ek_loaded"
    as far as clientheight of the tlayouter changes, then stages 2 & 3 are reapplied
 
  
* also, if {lao_scaletop in optionslayout} then top margins of the widgets
+
There can be more if the form is connected to object_event sending
  with unset "optionsskin.osk_noproptop" resize too otherwise retain
+
components or if the application uses object events, for example by calling
 +
tguicomponent.postcomponentevent. ****
  
*** only widget sizes & margins not distances between them are affected ***
+
onexit
 +
- see {any_widget.OnExit}
  
</pre>
+
onfocusedwidgetchanged
 +
- for a "prev-new" parent-wide focused wigdets pair, fires once installing new focus has finished,
 +
after "OnFocus"
 +
- resends for all contained widgets
 +
- doesn't fire if the "prev-new" pair don't really change
  
==== Stage 2 ====
+
onfontheightdelta
 +
- see {any_widget.OnFontHeightDelta}
  
Widgets may be auto resized in 5 consequent steps using the following options:
+
onhide
 +
- fires at beginnig of own/parent's
 +
= hide
 +
= hidden
 +
= destroying
 +
= setting "visible:= false"
 +
= closing the window ( receiving event "ek_close",.. )
 +
= calling "window.close"
 +
 +
onidle
 +
- fires everytime when the app GUI event queue gets empty
 +
- to stop calling for a while, set "again" parameter to "false" (the initial value );
 +
 +
DON'T DO ANYTHING AFFECTING THE APP EVENT QUEUE ( MODAL WINDOWS, "ShowMessage", Sleep(N),... ) IN THIS HANDLER.
 +
MODAL WINDOWS CAUSE RECURSION !
 +
 +
A code fragment:
  
<pre>
+
again:= i < 5;
 +
if not again then exit;
  
1. if plo_syncmaxautosize in place_options :
+
onkeydown
  = all widgets are autosized then their client areas are synchronised to the
+
- fires on pressing down a keyboard key over the client area when none of child widgets is focused
    clientareas of the highest and the widest of the widget
 
  * calls "msegui.syncmaxautosize"
 
  
2. if plo_syncpaintwidth in place_options :
+
onkeyup
  = the paintwidths of all widgets are synchronized to the widget with the
+
- fires on releasing a keyboard key over the client area when none of child widgets is focused
    widest outer frame width ( ex. width of "frame.caption" )
+
 
  * mainly makes sense if "lao_alignx" set and {align_glue = wam_start or wam_end}
+
onmouseevent
    ( see below ) when the widgets will be adjusted in order to fit into the
+
- fires on any mouse activity over the client area
    inner client width of tlayouter:
+
 
 +
onmove
 +
- see {any_window.OnMove}
  
                                  x-align level         
+
onpopup
                                        V               
+
- see {any_widget.OnPopup}
                        +----------------------------------+
 
                        | Widget_1 the_widest_frame_caption|
 
                        | Widget_2 frame_caption2          |
 
                        | Widget_N wider_frame_captionN    |
 
                        +----------------------------------+
 
  
  here, the effect is shown for "cp_right" frame captions
+
onresize
    // otherwise syncronizes to the outer ( of the frame except its caption ) width
+
- see {any_widget.OnResize}
    // of the Z-top widget
 
  * calls "msegui.syncpaintwidth"
 
  * paintwidth is the outer width
 
  
3. if plo_syncpaintheight in place_options :
+
onshortcut
  = the paintheights of all widgets are synchronized to the widget with the
+
- fires before built-in shorcut processing
    highest outer frame width ( ex. width of "frame.caption" ).
+
- "info.eventstate=es_processed" set in "OnShortcut" prevents
  * mainly makes sense if lao_aligny set and {align_glue = wam_start or wam_end}
+
the event from further auto-processing
    ( see below ) the widgets will be adjusted in order to fit into the inner
 
    client height of tlayouter :
 
  
                        +------------------------------+
+
The app
                        | The_                        |
+
- recognizes & takes registered shortcuts from app event queue
                        | tallest_            taller_  |
+
- passes the shocrcut event to each of its windows until the event
                        | frame_    frame_    frame_  |
+
is processed otherwise processes it by oneself
                        | caption  caption2  captionN | 
+
                        |                              |
 
                        | Widget1  Widget_2  Widget_N |<== y-align level
 
                        +------------------------------+   
 
  
  here, the effect is shown for "cp_topleft" frame captions
+
onshow
    // otherwise syncronizes to the outer ( of the frame except its caption )
+
- fires if the widget is visible:
    // height of the Z-top widget
+
= on calling "Show" method
  * calls "msegui.syncpaintheight"
+
= on return from "Loaded" procedure
+
= on showing the parent widget
4. plo_synccaptiondistx in place_options :
+
- since called at end, allows to adjust the default behavior
  = causes all widgets to have the widest common room for their cp_(left/right)* frame captions
+
 
  * calls "msegui.synccaptiondistx"
+
onshowhint
   
+
- see {any_widget.OnShowHint}
5. plo_synccaptiondisty in place_options :
+
 
  = causes all widgets to have the highest common room for their cp_(top/bottom)* frame captions
+
onstatbeforeread
  * calls "msegui.synccaptiondisty"
+
- fires before loading statvars from the disk file
</pre>
+
 
 +
onstatafterread
 +
- fires once statvars are loaded from the disk file
 +
 
 +
onstatupdate
 +
- fires at 1-st stage before updating GUI "state/pos" for read statvars
 +
or
 +
- fires at pre-last stage before saving GUI "state/pos"
  
==== Stage 3 ====
+
onstatread
 +
- fires at 2-nd stage before updating GUI "state/pos" for read statvars
  
The widgets may be (re)arranged within the layouter.
+
onstatwrite
 +
- fires at last stage before saving GUI "state/pos"
  
<pre>
+
pon stat reading, non-minimized visible windows are shown,
There're 2 modes of such (re)arrangement which can be partially (orthogonally)
+
the active window is activated
combined (see later):
 
  
1) The place(ment) mode ( lao_place* in optionslayout ) :
+
</pre>
 +
=== TDockFormWidget ===
 +
=== TPaintbox ===
  
- widgets are placed at some distances between each other, possibly with some
+
How to draw line (or circle) on tpaintbox? In event onpaint:
  margins, rooms of invisible widgets ( having visible=false) are also allocated
 
  unless "plo_noinvisible in place_options"
 
  
   * the widgets are placed in the order of decreasing their "widgetrect.x"
+
<syntaxhighlight lang=pascal>
coordinates before alignment
+
procedure tmainfo.paintboxonpaint(const sender: twidget; const canvas: tcanvas);
 
+
begin
  * the inter-widget distances and the side margins ( if apllied ) in both
+
   with sender,canvas do begin
dimentions are identical and limited between "place_mindist" and
+
  drawline(nullpoint,pointty(size),cl_yellow); 
"place_maxdist"
+
  //diagonal line across widget
 
+
  drawellipse(makerect(makepoint(bounds_cx div 2,bounds_cy div 2), size),cl_red);
  = if {lao_placex in optionslayout} and {place_mode <> wam_none} then the
+
  //circle (or ellipse) centered in widget                           
following relevant settings apply:
+
  end;
 
+
end;
* non-limiting value of "place_maxdist" :
+
</syntaxhighlight>
+
# |Widget_1------Widget_2------Widget_3|
+
Makepoint and makerect are in msegraphutils.
+
 
* non-limiting value of "place_maxdist" and {plo_propmargin in place_options} :
+
=== TEventWidget ===
+
A widget which publishes all possible events of a twidget. Normally it is better to implement your own specialized descendant of an existing widget instead to use teventwidget.
# |---Widget_1---Widget_2---Widget_3---|
+
 
+
=== TButton ===
* limiting value of "place_maxdist" and {place_mode = wam_start} :
+
* A rectangular clickable area that can show text/bitmap.
+
- Main properties:
# |Widget_1----Widget_2----Widget_3????|
+
Caption: read/write the text that appear on top of it.
+
onexecute: read/write the address of a procedure (event handler) to be executed when clicked.
* limiting value of "place_maxdist" and {place_mode = wam_start} and
+
 
  {plo_propmargin in place_options} :
+
=== TStockGlyphButton ===
+
=== TRichButton ===
# |---Widget_1---Widget_2---Widget_3???|
+
=== TLabel ===
+
* Draws a piece of text on the given surface (canvas: screen/printer/bitmap).
* limiting value of "place_maxdist" and {place_mode = wam_end} :
+
- Main properties:
+
Caption: read/write the piece of text.
# |??????Widget_1---Widget_2---Widget_3|
+
 
+
See also [[Reference:_MSEgui/TLabel|TLabel]]
* limiting value of "place_maxdist" and {place_mode = wam_end} and
+
 
  {plo_propmargin in place_options} :
+
=== TGroupBox ===
+
=== TStepBox ===
# |???Widget_1---Widget_2---Widget_3---|
+
=== TStringDisp ===
+
*A read only version of TStringEdit, difference from TLabel: has a frame around it.
* limiting value of "place_maxdist" and {place_mode = wam_center} :
+
-Main properties:
+
Value: read/write the text that are showed.
# |???Widget_1---Widget_2---Widget_3???|
+
Caption: A label normally describing the purpose or meaning of the presented text, it can be positioned around the frame.
+
 
* limiting value of "place_maxdist" and {plo_endmargin in place_options} :
+
=== TByteStringDisp ===
 +
=== TIntegerDisp ===
 +
=== TRealDisp ===
 +
=== TDateTimeDisp ===
 +
=== TBooleanDisp ===
 +
=== TToolBar ===
 +
=== TDrawGrid ===
 +
=== TStringGrid ===
 +
=== TTabBar ===
 +
=== TTabPage ===
 +
=== TTabWidget ===
 +
=== TDockHandle ===
 +
=== TDockPanel ===
 +
=== TSpliter ===
 +
<pre>
 +
      A widget very similar to "tspacer" but :
 +
- designed to rearrange areas occupied by adjacent widgets
 +
- a linked widget may only enlarge by "eating" the opposite one,
 +
so the summary area of both widgets don't change
 +
- has GUI look ( hatched grip, color etc) switched on by default
 +
- facilitates run-time repositioning oneself and linked widgets
 +
- linked widgets may even be other splitters, spacers (with their linked widgets ),..
 
 
# |Widget_1----Widget_2----Widget_____3|, or
+
        Properties:
+
 
# |Widget_1----Widget_____2----Widget_3|, or
+
- color
+
= see {any_widget.color}
# |Widget_____1----Widget_2----Widget_3|, here, the most left amongst
+
 
widgets having both [an_left,an_right] set is expanded otherwise the most
+
- cursor
right widget ( Widget_3 in the example )
+
= see {any_widget.cursor}
 
* limiting value of "place_maxdist" and {place_mode = wam_end} and
 
  {plo_propmargin in place_options} and {plo_endmargin in place_options} :
 
 
 
# |--Widget_1--Widget_____2--Widget_3--|,
 
 
 
The Legend:
 
===========
 
limiting value of "place_maxdist" : such value which produce some visual
 
effect on the layouter
 
 
  "----" :          distance ( = number of minuses, limited by place_maxdis )
 
  "????" :          some remaining space ( = number of questmarks )
 
  "Widget_1" :      widget of the original size
 
  "Widget__..__1" : (auto)resized widget
 
 
 
  = if {lao_placey in optionslayout} and {place_mode <> wam_none} then the things
 
are handled in the same manner as with "lao_placex" but for the vertical
 
"top2bottom" direction of placement instead of the horizontal "left2right" one.
 
  
2) the align(ment) mode ( optionslayout.lao_align* ) :
+
- enabled
 +
= "false" stops user interaction
  
- widgets are gathered into a visual group to a dedicated "leader" widget of
+
- face
  the layout ( set by "align_leader" and defaults to the lowest in
+
= see {any_face}
  Z-Order = twidget.widgets[0] ) the leader stays in place while the others :
 
  
  = if lao_alignx in optionslayout ( the hor alignment mode ):
+
- frame
  * if align_mode = wam_start :
+
= see {any_frame}
snap their left borders to the left border of leader
 
  * else if align_mode = wam_end :
 
snap their right borders to the right border of leader
 
  * else if align_mode = wam_center :
 
snap their v-axes to the v-axis of leader after that,
 
  = if lao_aligny in optionslayout ( the vert alignment mode ):
 
  * if align_mode = wam_start :
 
snap their top borders to the top border of leader
 
  * else if align_mode = wam_end :
 
snap their bottom borders to the bottom border of leader
 
  * else if align_mode = wam_center :
 
snap their h-axes to the h-axis of leader
 
  
- after that, the whole widget group can be aligned within the layouter:
+
- colorgrip
 +
= color of grip hatching
  
  = if align_glue =  wam_start
+
- grip
  * if lao_alignx in optionslayout:
+
= defines hatching pattern of the grip
the left extent of group snaps to the left border of layouter
 
  * if lao_aligny in optionslayout:
 
the top extent of group snaps to the top border of layouter
 
  = else if align_glue = wam_end
 
  * if lao_alignx in optionslayout:
 
the right extent of group snaps to the right border of layouter
 
  * if lao_aligny in optionslayout:
 
the bottom extent of group snaps to the bottom border of layouter
 
  = else if align_glue =  wam_center
 
  * if lao_alignx in optionslayout:
 
the v-axis of group snaps to the v-axis of layouter
 
  * if lao_aligny in optionslayout:
 
the h-axis of group snaps to the h-axis of layouter
 
  
Mutually exclusive settings:
+
* stb_dens(N) : the pattern is of rhombuses, the painted rhombs occupy "N" persents of the grip
* only one of "align_mode" can be choosen
 
* only one of "glue_mode" can be choosen
 
* "optionslayout.lao_alignx" & "optionslayout.lao_placex"
 
* "optionslayout.lao_aligny" & "optionslayout.lao_placey"
 
  
V-alignment ( optionslayout.lao_aligny ) may be combined with h-placement
+
* stb_block(N) : the pattern is of squares, painted & unpainted squares are equally sized and
( optionslayout.lao_placex ), and h-alignment ( optionslayout.lao_alignx ) may
+
both have "N" pixels sides
be combined with v-placement ( optionslayout.lao_placey )
+
 +
* stb_hatchup(N) : the pattern is of right-tilted lines of 1 pixel width,
 +
each "N"-th pixel forms these lines
  
NOTE:
+
* stb_hatchdown(N) : the pattern is of left-tilted lines of 1 pixel width,
  The effects of the above described { resizing / placement / alignment } are
+
each "N"-th pixel forms these lines
  irreversible. So, the only way to revert is to set "wan_none" then to revert
 
  manually.
 
</pre>
 
  
=== TListView ===
+
* stb_crosshatch(N) : the pattern is of crossing (left & right) tilted lines of 1 pixel width,
=== TImage ===
+
each "N"-th pixel forms these lines
<pre>
 
<any image>
 
  
*** Note that switch to the monochrome mode is irerreversible ! ***
 
  
alignment:
+
- linkbottom/linkleft/linkright/linktop
 +
= see {tspacer.*}
  
By default, images are top-left aligned, with the original size preserved.
+
- options
  
al_xcentered = centers the image horizontally
+
= spo_hmove
al_ycentered = centers the image vertically
+
* "true" allows the spliter to move horizontally
  
al_right = docks the image to the right border of placeholder
+
= spo_hprop
al_bottom = docks the image to the bottom border of placeholder
+
* "true" : keep the left position proportional ( on the ratio of creation time )
 +
to weigth of the client area of parent
  
al_grayed = fills non-transparent areas with the selected color
+
= spo_hsizeprop
 +
* "true" : keep width of the spacer proportional ( on the ratio of creation time )
 +
to weigth of the client area of parent
 +
* the width stops shrinking on one set in design time
  
al_stretchx = adjusts size so that to fill the placeholder in width
+
= spo_vmove
al_stretchy = adjusts size so that to fill the placeholder in height
+
* "true" allows the spliter to move vertically
al_fit = adjusts size so that to fill the placeholder in both width & height
 
  
al_tiled = spawns the image & tile the whole  placeholder with the copies
+
= spo_vprop
 +
* "true" : keep the top position proportional ( on the ratio of creation time )
 +
to height of the client area of parent
  
Interpolation mode while stretching
+
= spo_vsizeprop
 +
* "true" : keep height of the spacer proportional ( on the ratio of creation time )
 +
to height of the client area of parent
 +
* the height stops shrinking on one set in design time
  
al_intpol = antialiases as far as the size changes
+
= spo_dockleft
(the only working in Linux)
+
* causes the "linkleft" widget to dock to the left border of splitter
al_or = interpolation pixel operation is "or" -> 1's are extended
+
* make sence only if linkleft "widget.bounds_x" less than "splitter.bounds_x"
al_and = interpolation pixel operation is "and" -> 0's are extended
 
( al_or and al_and only on win32, mainly useful for stretching of monochrome bitmaps) :
 
  
colorbackground = color of image transparent ( masked ) areas in monochrome
+
= spo_docktop
non-masked mode
+
* causes the "linktop" widget to dock to the top border of splitter
colorforeground = color of non-transparent areas in monochrome mode 
+
* make sence only if linktop "widget.bounds_y" less than "splitter.bounds_y"
  
options:
+
= spo_dockright
 +
* causes the "linkright" widget to dock to the right border of splitter
 +
* make sence only if linkright "widget.(bounds_x+bounds_cx)" more than "splitter.(bounds_x+bounds_cx)"
  
bmo_monochrome = fills non-transparent areas with "colorforeground",
+
= spo_dockbottom
also, in non-masked mode, fills transparent areas
+
* causes the "linkbottom" widget to dock to the bottom border of splitter
with "colorbackground"
+
* make sence only if linkbottom "widget.(bounds_y+bounds_cy)" more than "splitter.(bounds_y+bounds_cy)"
  
bmo_masked = activates built-in image transparency {it "hides" transparent (masked) areas}
+
!!! Two special cases :
bmo_colormask = applies faded edge transparency on the color masked areas in the image
 
  
transparency = makes the image transparent as long as enlights areas behind
+
1. (spo_dockleft = spo_dockright = TRUE) && (linkleft = linkright = the_same_widget) :
the image with the selected color
+
causes the "linkleft" widget to adjust to h-positiion & width of the splitter,
 +
it's even possible that the widget doesn't touch the splitter
  
transparentcolor = for a non-masked image, assigns a color indicate transparency areas
+
(spo_docktop = spo_dockbottom = TRUE) && (linktop = linkbottom = the_same_widget) :
( on matching areas, the image will be seen through )
+
causes the "linktop" widget to adjust to v-position & height of the splitter,
<pre/>
 
  
=== TDial ===
+
It's even possible in these cases that the widget doesn't touch the splitter
=== TChart ===
 
=== TChartRecorder ===
 
=== TPolygon ===
 
=== TPickWidget ===
 
=== TOpenglWidget ===
 
  
== TWidget stuff ==
+
- optionsscale
<pre>
+
= see {tscalingwidget.optionsscale}
  Properties:   
+
 
- name
+
- optionswidget
- anchors
+
= see {anywidget.optionswidget}
- bounds
+
 
- color
+
- onactivate, onchildscaled, ondeactivate, ondefocus, onenter, onexit, onfocus,
- enabled
+
  onfontheightdelta, onmove, onpopup, onresize, onshowhint
- visible
+
= see "tspacer"
- <face> : see {any face}
+
 
- <frame> : see {any frame}
+
- onupdatelayout
    - hint
+
fires :
    - helpcontext
+
    - tag
+
= on creating the splitter
    - taborder
+
= on any reposition of the linked widgets
    - cursor
+
( due to moving the splitter, resizing the parent,.. )
    - optionswidget
+
</pre>
    - optionsskin
+
 
    - popupmenu
+
=== TSpacer ===
   
+
* a regular widget which creates a kind of positional link between surrounding widgets
twidget's event handlers:
+
* designed to maintain distances between widgets
   
+
* may have GUI look, caption etc switched off by default
- on(de)activate
+
* resizing a spacer repositions its linked widgets
- onbeforeupdateskin
 
- onafterupdateskin
 
- onchildscaled
 
- onfontheightdelta
 
- on(de)focus
 
- onenter
 
- onmove
 
- onpopup
 
- onresize
 
- onshowhint
 
     
 
align_glue :
 
  ( outer anchoring mode for widget group, in the align mode )
 
- wam_none
 
- wam_start
 
- wan_center
 
- wm_end
 
  
align_leader :  
+
Properties:
the widget ( incl another spacer, splitter or layouter ) against which the aligment applies ( the reference widget )
 
  
align_mode :
+
- anchors
  ( inner anchoring mode within widget group, in the align mode )
+
= see {any_widget.anchors}
- wam_none
 
- wam_start
 
- wan_center
 
- wm_end
 
  
// Place mode:
+
- bounds
 +
= see {any_widget.bounds}
  
     
+
- color
place_mindist, place_maxdist:
+
= see {any_widget.color}
- in the place(ment) mode, limits distance between widgets
 
  ( these distance once calclated also define side margins if aplicable )
 
  
place_mode:
+
- enabled
  ( outer anchoring mode for widget group, in the place mode )
+
= "false" turns color of the caption to gray
- wam_none
 
- wam_start
 
- wan_center
 
- wm_end
 
  
place_options:
+
- visible
- plo_endmargin
+
= "true" allows displayable settings (caption text, face, frame etc) to take
= to resize a widget so that it "eats" extra space if it occurs
+
effect in run-time as well
+
* only applicable in the place mode, with a limiting value of "place_maxdist" and:
+
- <face>
 +
= see {any face}
  
  1) {place_mode <> wam_none}
+
- <frame>
or
+
= see {any frame}
  2) {place_mode = wam_end} and {plo_propmargin in place_options}
 
  
For the exact look, see above
+
- linkbottom
 +
= widget linked down to most outer edge (incl. frame[.caption]) of the spacer
 +
- linkleft
 +
= widget linked left to most outer edge of the spacer
 +
- linkright
 +
= widget linked right to most outer edge of the spacer
 +
- linktop
 +
= widget linked up to most outer edge of the spacer
  
 +
- dist_bottom, dist_left, dist_right, dist_top :
 +
= margins between most outer edge the spacer
 +
and the corresponding linked widget
  
- plo_propmargin
+
- options :
= виджеты расставляются теснее так, чтобы образовались отступы перед и после,
 
  причем расстояние между центрами виджетов было бы таким же,
 
  как и растояние между серединами крайних виджетов и соотв. границами зоны расстановки
 
  
- plo_syncmaxautosize
+
= spao_glueright
= see above
 
  
- plo_synccaptiondistx
+
  - if "false"
= see above
 
  
  * affects widgets with opposite cp_left/right set as well
+
h-repositioning or h-resizing the linkleft widget shifts
  * the minimal before-adjustment "captiondist" amongst all widgets limits "captiondist" for each of the widget
+
the whole linked construction, it becomes the only way to h-shift
              * don't set cfo_captiondistouter here !
 
  
- plo_synccaptiondisty
+
if {an_right IN linkright_widget.anchors} then the spacer
= see above
+
may be right-resized with auto h-resizing the linkright widget
 +
so that the right margin of that widget is kept
  
  * affects also widgets with opposite cp_top/bottom set
+
if NOT {an_right IN linkright_widget.anchors} then the spacer
  * the minimal before-adjustment "captiondist" amongst all widgets limits "captiondist" for each of the widget
+
may be right-resized with auto h-shifting the linkright widget
 +
so that width of that widget is kept
  
              ! here, don't set "cfo_captiondistouter" for affected widgets !
+
- if "true"  
  
- plo_syncpaintwidth
+
h-repositioning or h-resizing the linkright widget shifts
= see above
+
the whole linked construction, it becomes the only way to h-shift
  
- plo_syncpaintheight
+
if {an_left IN linkleft_widget.anchors} then the spacer
= see above
+
may be h-resized with auto h-resizing the linkleft widget
 +
so that the left margin of that widget is kept
  
- plo_scalesize
+
if NOT {an_left IN linkleft_widget.anchors} then the spacer
= see above
+
may be h-resized with auto h-shifting the linkleft widget
 +
so that width of that widget is kept
  
 +
= spao_gluebottom
  
dist_left, dist_right, dist_top, dist_bottom :
+
- if "false"
= margins between most outer edge the layouter and
 
  the corresponding linked widget
 
  
* see "tspacer" for detail
+
v-repositioning or v-resizing the linktop widget shifts
 +
the whole linked construction, it becomes the only way to v-shift
  
linkleft,linkright,linktop,linkbottom : see "tspacer"
+
if {an_bottom IN linkbottom_widget.anchors} then the spacer
 +
may be v-resized with auto v-resizing the linkbottom widget
 +
so that the bottom margin of that widget is kept
  
options:
+
if NOT {an_bottom IN linkbottom_widget.anchors} then the spacer
- spao_glueright, spao_gluebottom:
+
may be v-resized with auto v-shifting the linkbottom widget
= set the adjustment dependencies between the layouter an its link_* widgets
+
so that height of that widget is kept
  
* see "tspacer" for more details
+
-  if "true"  
  
// which mode of widget placement to apply - see above
+
        v-repositioning or v-resizing the linkbottom widget shifts
optionslayout:
+
the whole linked construction, it becomes the only way to v-shift
- lao_alignx
 
- lao_aligny
 
- lao_placex
 
- lao_placey
 
- lao_scalewidth
 
- lao_scaleheight
 
- lao_scaleleft
 
- lao_scaletop
 
 
* lao_place* & lao_align* can't be combined for one direction
 
  
optionsscale:
+
if {an_top IN linktop_widget.anchors} then the spacer
 
+
may be v-resized with auto v-resizing the linktop widget
  * cause the layouter to provide full space for the widgets as long as they expand/shrink/move
+
so that the top margin of that widget is kept
  
- osc_expandx
+
if NOT {an_top IN linktop_widget.anchors} then the spacer
= allocates more h-space if needed
+
may be v-resized with auto v-shifting the linktop widget
 +
so that height of that widget is kept
  
- osc_shrinkx
+
- optionsscale
= removes extra h-space if occured
+
= see {tscalingwidget.optionsscale}
 +
 
 +
- optionswidget
 +
= see {anywidget.optionswidget}
  
- osc_expandy
+
- onactivate, onchildscaled, ondeactivate, ondefocus, onenter, onexit, onfocus,
= allocates more v-space if needed
+
  onfontheightdelta, onpopup, onresize, onshowhint
 +
= see {any_widget.*}
  
- osc_shrinky
+
- onmove
= removes extra v-space if occured
+
= see {any_window.OnMove}
  
- osc_invisishrinkx
+
any "link*" option set disables the spacer to reposition solely,
= fully h-collapses the layouter if "visible=false" ( run-time only )
+
repositioning is only controlled by a "glued" widget since then
  
- osc_invisishrinky
+
=== TLayouter ===
= fully v-collapses the layoter if "visible=false" ( run-time only )
+
* a tspacer descendant designed to (auto)resize or/and move its contained widgets acc to some size/positon dependencies
 +
* may have GUI look, frame caption etc switched off by default
 +
* layouters may be nested to achieve complex layouts
  
optionsskin:
+
Each layout change/assignment is divided into performing 3 consequent stages :
= see <any widget>
 
  
 +
==== Stage 1 ====
  
Methods:
+
Widgets auto resized using the following options:  
  
constructor create(aowner: tcomponent); override;
+
<pre>
 +
- if {lao_placex OR lao_placey} :
  
<pre/>
+
= if {plo_scalesize in optionslayout}  then
 +
* widgets with "osk_nopropwith" unset in their "optionsskin" are h-scaled
 +
    in the proportion of change of tlayouter's clientwidth
 +
* widgets with "osk_nopropheight" unset in their "optionsskin" are v-scaled
 +
    in the proportion  of change of tlayouter's clientheight
  
== Edit ==
+
For h-resized layouter, the effect looks like :
=== TStringEdit ===
 
=== TMemoEdit ===
 
=== THexStringEdit ===
 
=== TDropdownListEdit ===
 
A tstringedit with a dropdownlist to choose text values. Important dropdown.options members:
 
- deo_autodropdown dropdown on keypress
 
- deo_selectonly don't allow entering arbitrary text.
 
- deo_forceselect don't allow entering empty text.
 
  
=== THistoryEdit ===
+
|--Widget__1---Widget__2--| => the initial look
A tstringedit which shows the previously entered values in a dropdownlist for selection.
 
  
=== TIntegerEdit ===
+
  |--Widget_1--Widget_2--| => the layouter gets narrower
=== TKeyStringEdit ===
 
Maps string to string.
 
  
=== TEnumEdit ===
+
  |---Widget___1---Widget___2---| => the layouter gets wider
Maps integer to string, zero based and sequencial (first item 0, next 1, ...).
 
  
=== TEnumTypeEdit ===
+
*** both widget sizes & margins are affected ***
A tenumedit which maps Pascal enums to their names. Use oninit to store the typeinfo pointer of the enum type into sender.typeinfopo.
+
*** Widget_N may generally situate on different y-levels ***
 +
 
 +
otherwise :
  
=== TSelector ===
+
= if lao_scalewidth in optionslayout :
TSelector  is the most specialized widget of the dropdown editwidget group, it is based on tenumedit (tenumedit maps an integer to a string) and uses for the dropdownlist a second map which must be created on the fly in ongetdropdowninfo. An example is tcommselector where the enumedit maps commnrty to commname and the dropdownlist shows the available RS232 ports
+
* widgets with "osk_nopropwith" unset in their "optionsskin" enters in the mode
only.
+
  ( not applied until the layouter resizes! ) when they are h-scaled in the proportion
 +
  as far as clientwidth of the tlayouter changes, then stages 2 & 3 are reapplied
  
=== TRealEdit ===
+
For h-resized layouter, the effect looks like :
=== TRealSpinEdit ===
 
=== TDateTimeEdit ===
 
=== TCalendarDateTimeEdit ===
 
=== TEdit ===
 
MSEgui counterpart of Delphi TEdit. You will never use it.
 
  
=== TWidgetGrid ===
+
  |--Single____widget????| => the initial look
=== TItemEdit ===
 
=== TDropDownItemEdit ===
 
A tstringedit with a dropdownlist to choose text values. Important dropdown.options members:
 
- deo_autodropdown dropdown on keypress
 
- deo_selectonly don't allow entering arbitrary text.
 
- deo_forceselect don't allow entering empty text.
 
  
=== TMBDropDownItemEdit ===
+
  |--Single__widget???| => the layouter gets narrower
=== TTreeItemEdit ===
 
=== TRecordFieldEdit ===
 
Used in twidgetgrid in order to edit fields of a ttreeitemedit. Example is MSEide projecttreeform.pas.
 
  
=== TDialogStringEdit ===
+
  |--Single_______widget?????| => the layouter gets wider
A tstringedit with an ellipse button. Use "onexecute" to show the dialog.
 
  
=== TPointerEdit ===
+
* also, if {lao_scaleleft in optionslayout} then left margins of the widgets
=== TSlider ===
+
  with unset "optionsskin.osk_nopropleft" resize too otherwise retain
=== TProgressBar ===
 
=== TBooleanEdit ===
 
=== TBooleanEditRadio ===
 
=== TDataButton ===
 
A button with an integer value. Clicking increments the value until "max", then it restarts with "min". Can be inserted into a twidgetgrid. The current value selects the showed image and face by the items of "imagenums" and "valuefaces".
 
  
=== TStockGlyphDataButton ===
+
= if lao_scaleheight in optionslayout :
=== TDataIcon ===
+
* widgets with "osk_nopropheight" unset in their "optionsskin" enters in the mode
Shows an imagelist item by lookup from "value" to "imagenums". Clicking increments value until "max" then it restarts with "min". Can be inserted into a twidgetgrid.
+
  ( not applied until the layouter resizes! ) when they are v-scaled in the proportion
 +
    as far as clientheight of the tlayouter changes, then stages 2 & 3 are reapplied
  
=== TTextEdit ===
+
* also, if {lao_scaletop in optionslayout} then top margins of the widgets
Only useful if inserted into a twidgetgrid, builds a text editor, used in MSEide source editor.
+
  with unset "optionsskin.osk_noproptop" resize too otherwise retain
  
=== TDataImage ===
+
*** only widget sizes & margins not distances between them are affected ***
A pixmap display widget which can be inserted into twidgetgrid.
 
  
=== TTerminal ===
+
</pre>
Only useful if inserted into a twidgetgrid, builds a very simple terminal emulator. Used in MSEide target console.
 
  
== Properties for all widgets ==
+
==== Stage 2 ====
<pre>
 
  
name
+
Widgets may be auto resized in 5 consequent steps using the following options:
  
anchors
+
<pre>
  
-----------
+
1. if plo_syncmaxautosize in place_options :
 +
  = all widgets are autosized then their client areas are synchronised to the
 +
    clientareas of the highest and the widest of the widget
 +
  * calls "msegui.syncmaxautosize"
  
- they control of design/runtime sticking widgets to their parents
+
2. if plo_syncpaintwidth in place_options :
 +
  = the paintwidths of all widgets are synchronized to the widget with the
 +
    widest outer frame width ( ex. width of "frame.caption" )
 +
  * mainly makes sense if "lao_alignx" set and {align_glue = wam_start or wam_end}
 +
    ( see below ) when the widgets will be adjusted in order to fit into the
 +
    inner client width of tlayouter:
  
- dimention pair ( top/bottom or left/right ) both set to "false" cause
+
                                  x-align level         
the widget to fit the parent's client area in that dimention;
+
                                        V               
this effect may be partial in case of "bounds_c*max" settings limit the extents
+
                        +----------------------------------+
 +
                        | Widget_1 the_widest_frame_caption|
 +
                        | Widget_2 frame_caption2          |
 +
                        | Widget_N wider_frame_captionN    |
 +
                        +----------------------------------+
  
*** Return to the look "before dimention fit" is only possible by manual resizing or setting "bounds_*"
+
  here, the effect is shown for "cp_right" frame captions
-----------
+
    // otherwise syncronizes to the outer ( of the frame except its caption ) width
an_left
+
    // of the Z-top widget
- on run-time, resizes/shifts left the widget to keep the design-set distance
+
  * calls "msegui.syncpaintwidth"
between the widget's left border and the left side of parent's client area
+
  * paintwidth is the outer width
as the parent resizes, until scrolling begins
 
  
an_top
+
3. if plo_syncpaintheight in place_options :
- on run-time, resizes/shifts up the widget to keep the design-set distance
+
  = the paintheights of all widgets are synchronized to the widget with the
between the widget's top border and the upper side of parent's client area
+
    highest outer frame width ( ex. width of "frame.caption" ).
as the parent resizes, until scrolling begins
+
  * mainly makes sense if lao_aligny set and {align_glue = wam_start or wam_end}
 +
    ( see below ) the widgets will be adjusted in order to fit into the inner
 +
    client height of tlayouter :
  
an_right
+
                        +------------------------------+
- on run-time, resizes/shifts right the widget to keep the design-set distance
+
                        | The_                        |
between the widget's right border and the right side of parent's client area
+
                        | tallest_            taller_  |
as the parent resizes, until scrolling begins
+
                        | frame_    frame_    frame_  |
 +
                        | caption  caption2  captionN | 
 +
                        |                              |
 +
                        | Widget1  Widget_2  Widget_N |<== y-align level
 +
                        +------------------------------+   
  
an_bottom
+
  here, the effect is shown for "cp_topleft" frame captions
- on run-time, resizes/shifts down the widget to keep the design-set distance
+
    // otherwise syncronizes to the outer ( of the frame except its caption )
between the widget's bottom border and the lower side of parent's client area
+
    // height of the Z-top widget
as the parent resizes, until scrolling begins
+
  * calls "msegui.syncpaintheight"
 +
 +
4. plo_synccaptiondistx in place_options :
 +
  = causes all widgets to have the widest common room for their cp_(left/right)* frame captions
 +
  * calls "msegui.synccaptiondistx"
 +
 +
5. plo_synccaptiondisty in place_options :
 +
  = causes all widgets to have the highest common room for their cp_(top/bottom)* frame captions
 +
  * calls "msegui.synccaptiondisty"
 +
</pre>
  
bounds
+
==== Stage 3 ====
  
cx - width of the widget
+
The widgets may be (re)arranged within the layouter.
cxmax, cxmin - design/runtime width of the widget is enforced between "cxmax" and "cxmin"
 
cy - height of the widget
 
cymax, cymin - design/runtime height of the widget is enforced between "cymax" and "cymin"
 
x - distance between the widget's left border and the left side of parent's client area
 
y - distance between the widget's top border and the upper side of parent's client area
 
  
 +
<pre>
 +
There're 2 modes of such (re)arrangement which can be partially (orthogonally)
 +
combined (see later):
  
autosize
+
1) The place(ment) mode ( lao_place* in optionslayout ) :
  
-----------
+
- widgets are placed at some distances between each other, possibly with some
- only appliable to widgets with "ow_autosize" set
+
  margins, rooms of invisible widgets ( having visible=false) are also allocated
- the effect may be partial in case when "bounds_c*max" settings limit the extents
+
  unless "plo_noinvisible in place_options"
-----------
 
  
cx - addition to width of the widget (with h-centering post applied)
+
  * the widgets are placed in the order of decreasing their "widgetrect.x"
cy - addition to height of the widget (with v-centering post applied)
+
coordinates before alignment
 
+
 
- color
+
  * the inter-widget distances and the side margins ( if apllied ) in both
= the default color of client area & caption text background
+
dimentions are identical and limited between "place_mindist" and
= may be overwtitten:
+
"place_maxdist"
* the client area - with "frame.colorclient"
+
 
* the caption BG - with "frame.font.colorbackground"
+
  = if {lao_placex in optionslayout} and {place_mode <> wam_none} then the
 
+
following relevant settings apply:
- font
+
 
= see {any font}
+
* non-limiting value of "place_maxdist" :
 
+
- frame
+
# |Widget_1------Widget_2------Widget_3|
= see {any frame}
+
 
+
* non-limiting value of "place_maxdist" and {plo_propmargin in place_options} :
- face
+
= see {any face}
+
# |---Widget_1---Widget_2---Widget_3---|
 
+
- hint
+
* limiting value of "place_maxdist" and {place_mode = wam_start} :
= descriptive text appearing when mouse pointer enters the widget
+
 
+
# |Widget_1----Widget_2----Widget_3????|
- cursor
+
= shape of the mouse pointer over the client area of widget (run-time only)
+
* limiting value of "place_maxdist" and {place_mode = wam_start} and
 
+
  {plo_propmargin in place_options} :
- visible
+
= "true" allow the widget to appear ( run-time only )
+
# |---Widget_1---Widget_2---Widget_3???|
 
+
- enabled
+
* limiting value of "place_maxdist" and {place_mode = wam_end} :
= "true" allows the widget to participate in GUI interaction
+
= "false" disallows the widget & its childs :
+
# |??????Widget_1---Widget_2---Widget_3|
* processing all events & shortcuts & menu calls
+
* auto "CanClose" check
+
* limiting value of "place_maxdist" and {place_mode = wam_end} and
 
+
  {plo_propmargin in place_options} :
Also "false" usually aints the widget in color marking
+
the "disabled" state ( usually light gray font color )
+
# |???Widget_1---Widget_2---Widget_3---|
 
+
- popupmenu
+
* limiting value of "place_maxdist" and {place_mode = wam_center} :
= reference to a preset tpopupmenu widget serving the right-click menu
+
 +
# |???Widget_1---Widget_2---Widget_3???|
 +
 +
* limiting value of "place_maxdist" and {plo_endmargin in place_options} :
 +
 +
# |Widget_1----Widget_2----Widget_____3|, or
 +
 +
# |Widget_1----Widget_____2----Widget_3|, or
 +
 +
# |Widget_____1----Widget_2----Widget_3|, here, the most left amongst
 +
widgets having both [an_left,an_right] set is expanded otherwise the most
 +
right widget ( Widget_3 in the example )
 +
 +
* limiting value of "place_maxdist" and {place_mode = wam_end} and
 +
  {plo_propmargin in place_options} and {plo_endmargin in place_options} :
 +
 
 +
# |--Widget_1--Widget_____2--Widget_3--|,
 +
 
 +
The Legend:
 +
===========
 +
limiting value of "place_maxdist" : such value which produce some visual
 +
effect on the layouter
 +
 +
  "----" :          distance ( = number of minuses, limited by place_maxdis )
 +
  "????" :          some remaining space ( = number of questmarks )
 +
  "Widget_1" :      widget of the original size
 +
  "Widget__..__1" : (auto)resized widget
 +
 
 +
  = if {lao_placey in optionslayout} and {place_mode <> wam_none} then the things
 +
are handled in the same manner as with "lao_placex" but for the vertical
 +
"top2bottom" direction of placement instead of the horizontal "left2right" one.
  
- taborder
+
2) the align(ment) mode ( optionslayout.lao_align* ) :
- {0..N} order number when TAB-key cycling through widgets in the container
 
  
- tag
+
- widgets are gathered into a visual group to a dedicated "leader" widget of
- an integer value bound to this widget instance
+
  the layout ( set by "align_leader" and defaults to the lowest in
 +
  Z-Order = twidget.widgets[0] ) the leader stays in place while the others :
  
- helpcontext
+
  = if lao_alignx in optionslayout ( the hor alignment mode ):
= a string returned by "(active/mouse)helpcontext" methods of the owning form
+
  * if align_mode = wam_start :
  when this widget is focued or under mouse in the active window
+
snap their left borders to the left border of leader
 +
  * else if align_mode = wam_end :
 +
snap their right borders to the right border of leader
 +
  * else if align_mode = wam_center :
 +
snap their v-axes to the v-axis of leader after that,
 +
  = if lao_aligny in optionslayout ( the vert alignment mode ):
 +
  * if align_mode = wam_start :
 +
snap their top borders to the top border of leader
 +
  * else if align_mode = wam_end :
 +
snap their bottom borders to the bottom border of leader
 +
  * else if align_mode = wam_center :
 +
snap their h-axes to the h-axis of leader
  
- zorder
+
- after that, the whole widget group can be aligned within the layouter:
= reading: finds the current Z-order of the widget's window
 
= setting: if the value = 0 then lowers the widget's window in the stacking hierarchy, otherwise rises
 
  
 +
  = if align_glue =  wam_start
 +
  * if lao_alignx in optionslayout:
 +
the left extent of group snaps to the left border of layouter
 +
  * if lao_aligny in optionslayout:
 +
the top extent of group snaps to the top border of layouter
 +
  = else if align_glue = wam_end
 +
  * if lao_alignx in optionslayout:
 +
the right extent of group snaps to the right border of layouter
 +
  * if lao_aligny in optionslayout:
 +
the bottom extent of group snaps to the bottom border of layouter
 +
  = else if align_glue =  wam_center
 +
  * if lao_alignx in optionslayout:
 +
the v-axis of group snaps to the v-axis of layouter
 +
  * if lao_aligny in optionslayout:
 +
the h-axis of group snaps to the h-axis of layouter
  
optionswidget:
+
Mutually exclusive settings:
 
+
* only one of "align_mode" can be choosen
ow_background
+
* only one of  "glue_mode" can be choosen
- keeps the window/widget on bottom of the Z-order stack.
+
* "optionslayout.lao_alignx" & "optionslayout.lao_placex"
 
+
* "optionslayout.lao_aligny" & "optionslayout.lao_placey"
ow_top
 
- keeps the window/widget in foreground
 
  
ow_noautosizing
+
V-alignment ( optionslayout.lao_aligny ) may be combined with h-placement
- when docking, not to resize for the docking area
+
( optionslayout.lao_placex ), and h-alignment ( optionslayout.lao_alignx ) may
 +
be combined with v-placement ( optionslayout.lao_placey )
  
ow_mousefocus
+
NOTE:
- "false" here disables focusing the widget with mouse
+
  The effects of the above described { resizing / placement / alignment } are
  ( and "OnFocus" doesn't fire on mouse clicks )
+
  irreversible. So, the only way to revert is to set "wan_none" then to revert
 +
  manually.
 +
</pre>
  
ow_tabfocus
+
=== TListView ===
- "false" here disables focusing the widget with "TAB" key
+
=== TImage ===
  ( and "OnFocus" doesn't fire on TAB pressed )
+
<pre>
 +
<any image>
  
ow_parenttabfocus
+
*** Note that switch to the monochrome mode is irerreversible ! ***
- enters the childs on TAB-focusing then returns to the widget after
 
sequential TAB-ing through its child widgets,
 
otherwise TAB-ing cycles on the childs if entered
 
  
ow_arrowfocus
+
alignment:
- allows the widget ( and its childs in turn ) to be focused with
 
the arrow keys
 
  
ow_subfocus, ow_arrowfocusin, ow_arrowfocusout
+
By default, images are top-left aligned, with the original size preserved.
- in case of arrow keys focusing enabled for child-containing widget,
 
determine behaviour on entering & leaving the widget, see the below table:
 
  
ow_subfocus | ow_arrowfocusin | ow_arrowfocusout | effect
+
al_xcentered = centers the image horizontally
 +
al_ycentered = centers the image vertically
  
  FALSE          FALSE            FALSE        entering-/leaving-
+
al_right = docks the image to the right border of placeholder
  FALSE          FALSE            TRUE          entering-/leaving+
+
al_bottom = docks the image to the bottom border of placeholder
  FALSE          TRUE              FALSE        entering(nearest)+/leaving-
 
  FALSE          TRUE              TRUE          entering(nearest)+/leaving+
 
  TRUE            FALSE            FALSE        entering(last focused)+/leaving-
 
  TRUE            FALSE            TRUE          entering(last focused)+/leaving+
 
  TRUE            TRUE              FALSE        entering(nearest)+/leaving-
 
  TRUE            TRUE              TRUE          entering(nearest)+/leaving+
 
  
- "entering" is focusing on a child within the widget
+
al_grayed = fills non-transparent areas with the selected color
- "leaving"  is return from last child onto the widget's level
 
- "nearest" is the child closest on the arrow direction
 
- "last focused" is the child focused on last leaving the widget
 
 
*** The Up/Down arrow keys can leave from the childs circle,
 
but Left/Right can only toggle between the childs ***
 
  
*** mouse entering/leaving isn't controllable by these options
+
al_stretchx = adjusts size so that to fill the placeholder in width
 +
al_stretchy = adjusts size so that to fill the placeholder in height
 +
al_fit = adjusts size so that to fill the placeholder in both width & height
  
 +
al_tiled = spawns the image & tile the whole  placeholder with the copies
  
ow_focusbackonesc
+
Interpolation mode while stretching
- on pressing "Esc", returns input focus to the previously focused widget
 
  
ow_noparentshortcut
+
al_intpol = antialiases as far as the size changes
 +
(the only working in Linux)
 +
al_or = interpolation pixel operation is "or" -> 1's are extended
 +
al_and = interpolation pixel operation is "and" -> 0's are extended
 +
( al_or and al_and only on win32, mainly useful for stretching of monochrome bitmaps) :
  
*** disables processing of delegated ( from the parent ) shortcuts ***
+
colorbackground = color of image transparent ( masked ) areas in monochrome
 +
non-masked mode
 +
colorforeground = color of non-transparent areas in monochrome mode 
  
- "true" here disables processing shortcuts if they're delegated
+
options:
from the parent widget ( obviously, not processed by the parent )
 
  
ow_nochildshortcut
+
bmo_monochrome = fills non-transparent areas with "colorforeground",
 +
also, in non-masked mode, fills transparent areas
 +
with "colorbackground"
  
*** disables delegating shortcuts to the parent for taking desision ***
+
bmo_masked = activates built-in image transparency {it "hides" transparent (masked) areas}
 +
bmo_colormask = applies faded edge transparency on the color masked areas in the image
  
- if "true" then the widget tries to process it by oneself
+
transparency = makes the image transparent as long as enlights areas behind
otherwise it's passed to the parent widget for further chaining
+
the image with the selected color
  
*** A shortcut can only be processed once ( by one widget ) ***
+
transparentcolor = for a non-masked image, assigns a color indicate transparency areas
 +
( on matching areas, the image will be seen through )
 +
</pre>
  
ow_canclosenil
+
=== TDial ===
- "true" here allows to continue even if there's contained widget(s)
+
=== TChart ===
not passing "CanClose" check
 
  
ow_mousetransparent
+
There are demos here:
- "true" here causes the widget oneself ( not its contained ones )
 
not to react to mouse events ( just allow them through to the childs )
 
  
ow_mousewheel
+
https://github.com/mse-org/mseuniverse/tree/master/attic/msedocumenting/mse/trunk/help/tutorials/widgets/charts
- enables/disables {scrolling/navigating} with wheel of ImPS/2 etc mouse
 
  
ow_noscroll
+
=== TChartRecorder ===
- don't use screen image scrolling for twidget.scrollrect,
+
=== TPolygon ===
redraw the whole scrolled widget rectangle instead;
+
=== TPickWidget ===
sometimes needed with background fades.
+
=== TOpenglWidget ===
  
ow_nochildpaintclip
+
== Edit ==
-  
+
=== TStringEdit ===
 +
=== TMemoEdit ===
 +
=== THexStringEdit ===
 +
=== TDropdownListEdit ===
 +
A tstringedit with a dropdownlist to choose text values. Important dropdown.options members:
 +
- deo_autodropdown dropdown on keypress
 +
- deo_selectonly don't allow entering arbitrary text.
 +
- deo_forceselect don't allow entering empty text.
  
ow_destroywidgets
+
=== THistoryEdit ===
- "true" here causes calling "free" for all containing widgets as well
+
A tstringedit which shows the previously entered values in a dropdownlist for selection.
  
ow_hinton
+
=== TIntegerEdit ===
- to show the hint even in case of hinting is disabled on the parent
+
=== TKeyStringEdit ===
( "parent.ow_hintoff= true & parent.ow_hinton= false" )
+
Maps string to string.
  
ow_hintoff
+
=== TEnumEdit ===
- "true" here combined with "ow_hinton=false" fully disables displaying the hint
+
Maps integer to string, zero based and sequencial (first item 0, next 1, ...).
  
ow_multiplehint
+
=== TEnumTypeEdit ===
- "true" here causes the widget to redisplay its hint on each {>3px} move within the widget oneself
 
  
*mse ow_timedhint
+
A TEnumEdit which maps Pascal enums to their names. Use OnInit event to store the typeinfo pointer of the enum type into '''sender.typeinfopo'''.
- "true" here causes hint of the widget to disappear after a timed inteval (about 2 secs by default)
 
  
ow_fontlineheight (design-time only)
+
<syntaxhighlight lang=pascal>
- causes "extraspace" of the last text line to be drawn,
+
procedure tmainfo.enumtypeeditinit(const sender: tenumtypeedit);
in turn it causes adjustment of widget height if "ow_autoscale" is set
+
begin
+
  sender.typeinfopo := PTypeInfo(TypeInfo(TMyEnumeratedType));
*** makes sence only if "ow_autoscale=true" & ow_autosize=false & "extraspace <> 0" ***
+
end;
 +
</syntaxhighlight>
  
ow_fontglyphheight (design-time only)
+
=== TSelector ===
- causes only interline "extraspace"-s to be drawn, opposite to "ow_fontlineheight"
+
TSelector  is the most specialized widget of the dropdown editwidget group, it is based on tenumedit (tenumedit maps an integer to a string) and uses for the dropdownlist a second map which must be created on the fly in ongetdropdowninfo. An example is tcommselector where the enumedit maps commnrty to commname and the dropdownlist shows the available RS232 ports
 +
only.
  
ow_autoscale (design-time only)
+
=== TRealEdit ===
- causes that if the contents change (design OR run-time) so that its' height changes
+
=== TRealSpinEdit ===
then the widget will be v-scaled as well
+
=== TDateTimeEdit ===
 +
=== TCalendarDateTimeEdit ===
 +
=== TEdit ===
 +
MSEgui counterpart of Delphi TEdit. You will never use it.
  
ow_autosize (design-time only)
+
=== TWidgetGrid ===
- causes that widget's heigh & width & client area adjust so that to provide space for contents of the client area
+
=== TItemEdit ===
- no desing-time change of height/width are possible as long as this option is in effect
+
=== TDropDownItemEdit ===
 
+
A tstringedit with a dropdownlist to choose text values. Important dropdown.options members:
ow_autosizeanright
+
- deo_autodropdown dropdown on keypress
- when autosizing & {an_right isn't set}, the design-set right margin against the parent is preserved
+
- deo_selectonly don't allow entering arbitrary text.
 +
- deo_forceselect don't allow entering empty text.
  
ow_autosizeanbottom
+
=== TMBDropDownItemEdit ===
- when autosizing & {an_bottom isn't set}, the design-set bottom margin against the parent is preserved
+
=== TTreeItemEdit ===
 +
=== TRecordFieldEdit ===
 +
Used in twidgetgrid in order to edit fields of a ttreeitemedit. Example is MSEide projecttreeform.pas.
  
optionsskin:
+
=== TDialogStringEdit ===
 +
A tstringedit with an ellipse button. Use "onexecute" to show the dialog.
  
- osc_noskin
+
=== TPointerEdit ===
- osc_framebuttononly
+
=== TSlider ===
- osc_container
+
=== TProgressBar ===
 +
=== TBooleanEdit ===
 +
=== TBooleanEditRadio ===
 +
=== TDataButton ===
 +
A button with an integer value. Clicking increments the value until "max", then it restarts with "min". Can be inserted into a twidgetgrid. The current value selects the showed image and face by the items of "imagenums" and "valuefaces".
  
 +
=== TStockGlyphDataButton ===
 +
=== TDataIcon ===
 +
Shows an imagelist item by lookup from "value" to "imagenums". Clicking increments value until "max" then it restarts with "min". Can be inserted into a twidgetgrid.
  
Methods:
+
=== TTextEdit ===
 +
Only useful if inserted into a twidgetgrid, builds a text editor, used in MSEide source editor.
  
  // tmsecomponent
+
=== TDataImage ===
 +
A pixmap display widget which can be inserted into twidgetgrid.
  
// (re)draws the widget according to the related skin if apllicable;
+
=== TTerminal ===
//
+
Only useful if inserted into a twidgetgrid, builds a very simple terminal emulator. Used in MSEide target console.
// also called internally by "loaded" procedure ( before "OnLoaded" code ),
+
 
// by ShowMessage ( for the internal widgets of the message dialogue ),
+
== NoGui ==
// when creating tab & form & menu widgets
+
=== TAction ===
procedure updateskin(const recursive: boolean = false);
+
<pre>
 +
Shortcut processing order :
  
// TRUE if the instance is created but not yet ready
+
- the smallest piece of processing is "doshortcut" procedure which
// for interaction & accessing data & appearance change & receiving events etc
+
is called until processed:
// ( the stage between firing "OnCreate" & "OnLoaded" )
+
= starting from the sender up to the toplevel widget
function loading: boolean;
+
= then by all child widgets with non-set "ow_noparentshortcut"  
 +
= then, if "ow_nochildshortcut" isn't set, by the parent widget
 +
= then by the widget oneself
 
 
{$ifdef FPC}
+
- "doshortcut" is checked in the following order:
procedure setinline(value: boolean); // ?
+
= starting from form's main menu
procedure setancestor(value: boolean); // ?
+
= then from the owning window ( the widget oneself )  
{$endif}
+
= then from the application
  
// TRUE if all conditios are OK for executing the code of "event" ( a handler must be assigned to the event )
 
function canevent(const event: tmethod): boolean;
 
  
 +
*** A shortcut is bound to a widget by :
 +
- placing an action component on the widget ***
 +
- direct assigning the shortcut to the widget (menus,..)
 +
---------------------------
  
// Shortly, replaces the persistent storage of the widget
+
caption, color, colorglyph, helpcontext, hint, imagecheckedoffset,
//
+
imagelist <see "timagelist">, imagenr, imagenrdisabled
// if {value <> nil} then
 
// - if "instance" is nil then calls "createproc" to create the instance,
 
//    then assigns the instance's value:= "value"
 
// otherwise frees "instance"
 
procedure setoptionalobject(const value: tpersistent; var instance;
 
                        createproc: createprocty);
 
  
// creates the persistent storage of the widget via calling "createproc"
+
- sets look of "clients" (buttons, menu/toolbar items,..), unless
procedure getoptionalobject(const instance: tobject; createproc: createprocty);
+
these clients have "state.as_local*" set :
  
// obtains & puts to "obj" a CORBA interface entry for "aintf" (GUID,...)
+
*** For meaning of these options, see help on the "client" widgets ***
function getcorbainterface(const aintf: ptypeinfo; out obj) : boolean;
 
  
        // TRUE if the widget is owned, or "self" otherwise
+
group
function checkowned(component: tcomponent): boolean;
+
- default value for one-named property of the bound widgets
 +
( menu items,... )
  
        // TRUE if the widget is owner, or "self" otherwise
+
options :
function checkowner(component: tcomponent): boolean;
+
ao_updateonidle
 +
- runs this action in cycle, waiting for no gui events everytime
  
// return the top-most widget in owner chain starting from this widget
+
ao_globalshortcut
function rootowner: tcomponent;
+
- allows the action to trigger on a non-main form
 +
  (the shortcut is triggered whatever form of the applicatin it was pressed on,
 +
  otherwise only when the form where the aption is placed on is focused )
  
// return the array of owning widgets starting from this widget
+
ao_nocandefocus
// componentarty[0] is the widget oneself
+
- causes the action not to call "CanDefocus" for focused edit widget of active form
function getrootcomponentpath: componentarty;
+
  before executing own code
 +
  ( it helps to avoid the effect of cancelling changes in these widgets  
 +
  on activating the bound shortcut )
  
        // returns items of objeclinker ( which notify this widget )
+
shortcut
        // and free notify list ( which are notified by this widget ),
+
- keyboard combination triggering the action
        // duplicates are removed.
 
        //
 
        // Notifies mainly relate to insertion/removal operation on widgets
 
        // The notify list is maintained by FreeNotification & RemoveFreeNotification
 
function linkedobjects: objectarty;
 
  
// sends "event" recursively to child widgets until no more childs or
+
shortcut
// the event is processed ( cea_processed ) by one of the childs,
+
- alternative "shortcut" and handled identically
// "event" will be destroyed if destroyevent= true and not async
 
procedure sendcomponentevent(const event: tcomponentevent;
 
                                        const destroyevent: boolean = true);
 
  
// sends "event" to each of owning widgets downward from the root owner,
+
state :
// "event" will be destroyed if destroyevent= true and not async
 
procedure sendrootcomponentevent(const event: tcomponentevent;
 
                                        const destroyevent: boolean = true);
 
  
// posts an async "atag"-ged event to be handled by oneself
+
as_disabled
procedure asyncevent(atag: integer = 0);
+
- prevents the action from triggering, also puts the bound widgets to "disabled" look
  
// posts a "tcomponentevent" instance from sender=self,  
+
as_invisible
// "kind" is defined when creating the event,  
+
- in run-time, hides the bound widget, still reacting on the shortcut or direct call
// and "tag" may be adjusted after creation
 
procedure postcomponentevent(const event: tcomponentevent);
 
  
// returns the classname of the widget if the widget is toplevel,
+
as_checked
// and "tmsecomponent" otherwise )
+
- selects the bound menu item if it has "mao_checkbox" option set
property moduleclassname: string read getmoduleclassname;
 
  
// returns the classname of the widget as the entry of its constructor
+
as_default
// ( button => tbutton, datamodule => tdm1mo, form => ttstfo, dbstringedit => tdbstringedit,.. )
+
as_local*
property actualclassname: string read getactualclassname;
 
  
// returns "fmsecomponentstate"
+
statfile
// ( a set of cs_ismodule,cs_endreadproc,cs_loadedproc,cs_noload, cs_hasskin,cs_noskin )
+
<see "tstatfile">
property msecomponentstate: msecomponentstatesty read fmsecomponentstate;
 
  
// returns/sets a pointer associated with the widget
+
stavarname
// ( contrary to the integer "tag", allows to use an arbitary data type
 
// for associating data )
 
property tagpo: pointer read ftagpo write ftagpo;
 
  
// returns/sets a string identifying the widget in the help system
+
property helpcontext: msestring read gethelpcontext write fhelpcontext;
+
tagaction
 +
onasyncevent
 +
onchange
 +
onexecute
 +
onupdate
 +
</pre>
  
// twidget
+
=== TActivator ===
 +
=== TCustomLookupbuffer ===
 +
<pre>
 +
- provides a group of parallel arrays of float(=datetime), integer and widestring types,
 +
and facilities to :
 +
= search in any array
 +
= on found position, quickly obtain corresponding value in another array
 +
- for each type, several arrays  may be kept
 +
- each array is integer-indexed, even string ones ( case[in]sensitive )
 +
- uses two way of accessing arrays data, through :
 +
= physic : array storage index ( row number ) directly
 +
= logical : the integer index ( see above ):
 +
first, physic row number is known for the logical index then the data
 +
are accessed with the found number
  
// creates an instance of the widget, owned by "aowner" if not NIL
+
*** logical index values are built automatically based on array values,  
constructor create(aowner: tcomponent); override;
+
on updating its data ***
 +
- dont' have interface to load data ( see its descendants for that )
 +
 +
fieldcountfloat - number of float arrays
 +
fieldcountinteger - number of integer arrays
 +
fieldcounttext - number of widestring arrays
  
destructor destroy; override;
+
Event handlers:
 +
- onchange
 +
 
 +
Public interface:
 +
 
 +
  procedure beginupdate; - marks beginning of "update"
 +
  procedure endupdate; - if all "update" finished, fires "onchange" event
 +
procedure clearbuffer; - clears all arrays then fires "onchange"
 +
 
 +
  procedure checkbuffer;
 +
  - [re]loads the arrays with most actual data
 +
  - just a stub here since doesn't have a data source
 +
 
 +
  function find(const fieldno: integer; const avalue: integer/realty/msestring;
 +
        out aindex: integer; const filter: lbfiltereventty = nil): boolean;
 +
- applies external filtering ("filter" procedure) then incrementally searches integer/realty(datetime) array "fieldno"
 +
for value "avalue" starting from logical index "aindex", returns "true" and the updated logical index
 +
if found else next bigger;  
  
// ??
+
  function find(const fieldno: integer; const avalue: msestring;
procedure afterconstruction; override;
+
                out aindex: integer;
 +
                const caseinsensitive: boolean;
 +
                const filter: lbfiltereventty = nil): boolean; overload;
 +
- applies external filtering ("filter" procedure) then incrementally searches widestring array "fieldno" for value "avalue",
 +
in "caseinsensitive" manner, starting from logical index "aindex", returns "true" and the updated logical index
 +
if found else next bigger;
  
// rescales the widget frame ( if assigned ) then owned widgets ( if exist, recursively ) then bounds_* then the font ( if assigned )
+
  function findphys(const fieldno: integer; const avalue: integer;
// called before inserting in parentwidget,
+
        out aindex: integer; const filter: lbfiltereventty = nil): boolean; overload;
// calls "scale(ascale)",
+
- applies external filtering ("filter" procedure) then incrementally searches integer/realty(datetime) array "fieldno"
// no visual repainting
+
for value "avalue" starting from row number "aindex", returns "true" and the updated row number
procedure initnewcomponent(const ascale: real); virtual;
+
if found else next bigger;  
  
// restores the "fontheight" to "font.glyphheight" if "ow_fontglyphheight" or
+
function findphys(const fieldno: integer; const avalue: msestring;  out aindex: integer; const caseinsensitive: boolean;
// to "font.lineheight" if "ow_fontlineheight" otherwise,
+
                const filter: lbfiltereventty = nil): boolean; overload;
// ascale is ignored ?
+
- applies external filtering ("filter" procedure) then incrementally searches widestring array "fieldno" for value "avalue",
// calls "synctofontheight->setfontheight",
+
in "caseinsensitive" manner, starting from row number "aindex", returns "true" and the updated row number 
// called after inserting in parentwidget,
+
if found else next bigger;
// no visual repainting
 
procedure initnewwidget(const ascale: real); virtual;
 
  
// creates the widget frame if not yet created
+
The external filtering ("filter") procedure takes the arguments of the caller
procedure createframe;
+
togehther with physical row number found in the caller which allows
 +
to check several values at once for that number, within the filter
 +
 +
function integervaluephys(const fieldno,aindex: integer): integer;
 +
-  returns value of integer array "fieldno" at row number "aindex"
 +
             
 +
function integervaluelog(const fieldno,aindex: integer): integer;
 +
-  returns value of integer array "fieldno" where the array index equals to "aindex"
  
// creates the widget face if not yet  created
+
function integerindex(const fieldno,aindex: integer): integer;
procedure createface;
+
- returns row number of integer array "fieldno" where the array index equals to "aindex"
  
// creates the widget font if not yet  created
+
function integerindexar(const fieldno: integer): integerarty;
procedure createfont;
+
- returns all bunch of indexes of integer array "fiedlno"
  
// checks ws_loadlock and csdestroing too
+
function integerar(const fieldno: integer): integerarty;
function isloading: boolean;
+
- returns all bunch of data of integer array "fiedlno"
 +
 
 +
function floatvaluephys(const fieldno,aindex: integer): realty;
 +
-  returns value of real/datetime array "fieldno" at row number "aindex"
  
// returns "widgetstatety" - a set of (
+
function floatvaluelog(const fieldno,aindex: integer): realty;
// ws_visible,ws_enabled,ws_active,ws_entered,ws_entering,ws_exiting,
+
-  returns value of real/datetime array "fieldno" where the array index equals to "aindex"
// ws_focused,ws_mouseinclient,ws_wantmousebutton,ws_wantmousemove,
 
// ws_wantmousefocus,ws_iswidget,ws_opaque,ws_nopaint,
 
// ws_clicked,ws_mousecaptured,ws_clientmousecaptured,
 
// ws_loadlock,ws_loadedproc,ws_showproc,ws_minclientsizevalid,
 
// ws_showed,ws_hidden, //used in tcustomeventwidget
 
// ws_destroying,ws_staticframe,ws_staticface,ws_isvisible
 
//
 
// iframe
 
function widgetstate: widgetstatesty;
 
  
// returns "widgetstate1ty" - a set of (
+
function floatindex(const fieldno,aindex: integer): integer;
// (ws1_childscaled,ws1_fontheightlock,
+
- returns row number of real/datetime array "fieldno" where the array index equals to "aindex"
// ws1_widgetregionvalid,ws1_rootvalid,
 
// ws1_anchorsizing,ws1_isstreamed,
 
// ws1_scaled, //used in tcustomscalingwidget
 
// ws1_noclipchildren,
 
// ws1_nodesignvisible,ws1_nodesignframe,ws1_nodesignhandles,
 
// ws1_nodesigndelete,ws1_designactive,
 
// ws1_fakevisible,ws1_nominsize //used for report size calculations
 
// )
 
property widgetstate1: widgetstates1ty read fwidgetstate1;
 
 
* this set of states is needed because the max FPC set size is 32
 
  thus "widgetstate1ty" can't fit all states
 
  
// TRUE if the widget is contained within another widget
+
function floatindexar(const fieldno: integer): integerarty;
// ( tcomponent stuff )
+
- returns all bunch of indexes of real/datetime array "fiedlno"
function hasparent: boolean; override;             
 
  
// returns the parent component if it's a widget or the grandparent otherwise
+
function floatar(const fieldno: integer): realarty;
function getparentcomponent: tcomponent; override//tcomponent
+
- returns all bunch of data of real/datetime array "fiedlno"    
  
// TRUE if "awidget" is an ascendant or the widget or they are the same widget
+
function textvaluephys(const fieldno,aindex: integer): msestring;
function checkdescendent(awidget: twidget): boolean;
+
-  returns value of widestring array "fieldno" at row number "aindex"
 
// TRUE if app is running and the widget owns the caret or the caret widget
 
function hascaret: boolean;
 
  
        // TRUE if "winid" allocated and not loading and not destroying,
+
function textvaluelog(const fieldno,aindex: integer;
        // all widgets on a form have "winid" of this form ( a real window allocated by the OS )
+
                      const caseinsensitive: boolean): msestring;
        // thus have this function TRUE
+
-  returns value of widestring array "fieldno" where the array index equals to "aindex"
function windowallocated: boolean;
 
  
// TRUE if presents a valid toplevelwindow with assigned "winid"
+
function textindex(const fieldno,aindex: integer;
function ownswindow: boolean;
+
                      const caseinsensitive: boolean): integer;
 +
- returns row number of widestring array "fieldno" where the array index equals to "aindex"
  
// invalidated area of the widget, the origin is "clientpos" against the roor widget
+
function textindexar(const fieldno: integer;
function updaterect: rectty;
+
                            const caseinsensitive: boolean): integerarty;
 +
- returns all bunch of indexes of widestring array "fiedlno"
  
// calls recursively "canclose" for all contained widgets ( the widget oneself excluded! ),
+
function textar(const fieldno: integer): msestringarty;
// TRUE if none of the widgets return FALSE
+
- returns all bunch of data of widestring array "fiedlno" 
//
 
// more specialized widgets may have "canclose" overridden
 
// to perform more work than just this call recursion
 
// ( not null or range check,.. )
 
//
 
// "onclosequery" must also pass the check if assigned, for the function to succeed
 
function canclose(const newfocus: twidget = nil): boolean; virtual;
 
  
        // checks "canclose" first for focused widget of the window ( form,.. )
+
 
        // if it is a descendant of the widget or the widget oneself,
+
function lookupinteger(const integerkeyfieldno,integerfieldno,
        // then continues with subwidgets of the widget;
+
                                keyvalue: integer): integer; overload;
        // also - finishes editing ( snapshots "value" ) in the focused widget before checking
+
- returns value of integer array "integerfieldno" at position where
function canparentclose(const newfocus: twidget): boolean; overload;
+
value of parallel integer array "integerkeyfieldno" equals to "keyvalue"
 +
                ( 0 if not found )
  
// the above function but with the preserved focus
+
function lookupinteger(const stringkeyfieldno,integerfieldno: integer;
function canparentclose: boolean; overload;
+
                        const keyvalue: msestring): integer; overload;
                  //newfocus = window.focusedwidget     
+
- returns value of integer array "integerfieldno" at position where
 +
value of parallel widestring array "stringkeyfieldno" equals to "keyvalue"
 +
                ( 0 if not found )
  
function canfocus: boolean; virtual;
+
function lookuptext(const integerkeyfieldno,textfieldno,
function setfocus(aactivate: boolean = true): boolean; virtual;//true if ok
+
                                keyvalue: integer): msestring; overload;
procedure nextfocus; //sets inputfocus to then next appropriate widget
+
- returns value of integer array "textfieldno" at position where
 +
value of parallel integer array "integerkeyfieldno" equals to "keyvalue"
 +
                ( '' if not found )
  
function findtabfocus(const ataborder: integer): twidget;
+
function lookuptext(const stringkeyfieldno,textfieldno: integer;
                      //nil if can not focus
+
                      const keyvalue: msestring): msestring; overload;
 +
- returns value of integer array "textfieldno" at position where
 +
value of parallel integer array "integerkeyfieldno" equals to "keyvalue"
 +
                ( '' if not found )
  
function firsttabfocus: twidget;
 
function lasttabfocus: twidget;
 
function nexttaborder(const down: boolean = false): twidget;
 
  
function focusback(const aactivate: boolean = true): boolean;
+
function lookupfloat(const integerkeyfieldno,floatfieldno,
                              //false if focus not changed
+
                                keyvalue: integer): realty; overload;
 +
- returns value of real/datetime array "floatfieldno" at position where
 +
value of parallel integer array "integerkeyfieldno" equals to "keyvalue"
 +
                ( emptyreal if not found )
  
function parentcolor: colorty;
+
function lookupfloat(const stringkeyfieldno,floatfieldno: integer;
function actualcolor: colorty; virtual;
+
                                keyvalue: msestring): realty; overload;
function actualopaquecolor: colorty;
 
function backgroundcolor: colorty;
 
function translatecolor(const acolor: colorty): colorty;
 
  
procedure widgetevent(const event: twidgetevent); virtual;
+
- returns value of real/datetime array "floatfieldno" at position where
 +
value of parallel widestring array "stringkeyfieldno" equals to "keyvalue"
 +
                ( emptyreal if not found )
  
procedure sendwidgetevent(const event: twidgetevent);
+
function count: integer; - returns number of data rows
                              //event will be destroyed
 
  
procedure release; override;
+
property fieldcounttext: integer; -  returns/sets number of widestring arrays
 +
property fieldcountfloat: integer; - returns/sets number of real/datetime arrays
 +
property fieldcountinteger: integer; - returns/sets number of integer arrays
  
function show(const modal: boolean = false;
+
the above "fieldcount*" props clear the buffer on setting a value
            const transientfor: twindow = nil): modalresultty; virtual;
 
  
procedure hide;
+
property integervalue[const fieldno,aindex: integer]: integer; - a shortcut to "integervaluephys"
procedure activate(const abringtofront: boolean = true); virtual;
+
property floatvalue[const fieldno,aindex: integer]: realty; - a shortcut to "floatvaluephys"
                            //show and setfocus
+
property textvalue[const fieldno,aindex: integer]: msestring; - a shortcut to "textvaluephys"
  
procedure bringtofront;
+
property onchange: notifyeventty;  
procedure sendtoback;
+
- called in "changed" wich in turn is called in :
procedure stackunder(const predecessor: twidget);
+
= clearbuffer
 +
= endupdate
 +
= doasyncevent
 +
= loaded
 +
= tlookupbuffer.addrow
  
procedure paint(const canvas: tcanvas); virtual;
+
</pre>
procedure update; virtual;
 
procedure scrollwidgets(const dist: pointty);
 
  
procedure scrollrect(const dist: pointty; const rect: rectty; scrollcaret: boolean);
+
=== TLookupBuffer ===
                            //origin = paintrect.pos
+
<pre>
 +
tlookupbuffer = class(tcustomlookupbuffer)
  
procedure scroll(const dist: pointty);
+
- extends "tcustomlookupbuffer" with methods of run-time data filling
                            //scrolls paintrect and widgets
 
  
procedure getcaret;
+
- see <tcustomlookupbuffer>
procedure scrollcaret(const dist: pointty);
 
function mousecaptured: boolean;
 
procedure capturemouse(grab: boolean = true);
 
procedure releasemouse;
 
procedure capturekeyboard;
 
procedure releasekeyboard;
 
procedure synctofontheight; virtual;
 
  
procedure dragevent(var info: draginfoty); virtual;
+
+= Extentions to the public interface:
procedure dochildscaled(const sender: twidget); virtual;
 
  
procedure invalidatewidget;     //invalidates whole widget
+
procedure addrow(const integervalues: array of integer;
procedure invalidate;           //invalidates clientrect
+
                    const textvalues: array of msestring;
procedure invalidaterect(const rect: rectty; org: originty = org_client);
+
                    const floatvalues: array of realty);
procedure invalidateframestate;
 
  
procedure invalidateframestaterect(const rect: rectty;
+
- adds one row to each of widestring arrays, integer arrays and real/datetime arrays,
                                        const org: originty = org_client); 
+
array size of  "{type}values" equals to number of {type} arrays
function hasoverlappingsiblings(arect: rectty): boolean; //origin = pos
 
  
function window: twindow;
+
  procedure addrows(const integervalues: array of integerarty;
function rootwidget: twidget;
+
                    const textvalues: array of msestringarty;
 +
                    const floatvalues: array of realarty);
  
function parentofcontainer: twidget;
+
- adds many data rows  to each of widestring arrays, integer arrays and real/datetime arrays,
            //parentwidget.parentwidget if parentwidget has not ws_iswidget,
+
only min length of the input data arrays are inserted, longer data are truncated
            //parentwidget otherwise
+
array size of  "{type}values" equals to number of {type} arrays and the size of "{type}values[i]"
 +
describes number od data elements in the array
 +
 +
</pre>
  
property parentwidget: twidget read fparentwidget write setparentwidget;
+
=== TDBLookupBuffer ===
function getrootwidgetpath: widgetarty; //root widget is last
+
<pre>
 +
tdblookupbuffer = class(tcustomdblookupbuffer -> tcustomlookupbuffer)
  
// number of contained widgets ( the widget oneself excluded ! )
+
- extends "tcustomlookupbuffer" with interface to fill arrays with DB-data
function widgetcount: integer;
+
- see <tcustomlookupbuffer> & <tcustomdblookupbuffer>
  
function parentwidgetindex: integer; //index in parentwidget.widgets, -1 if none
+
Extentions to the public interface:
property widgets[const index: integer]: twidget read getwidgets;
 
function widgetatpos(var info: widgetatposinfoty): twidget; overload;
 
function widgetatpos(const pos: pointty): twidget; overload;
 
  
function widgetatpos(const pos: pointty;  
+
  procedure checkbuffer; - if data obsolete ("invalid") then reloads them from "datasource"
                  const state: widgetstatesty): twidget; overload;
+
 
 +
property datasource: tdatasource; - sets/returns DB data source where to load data from
 +
property textfields: tdbfieldnamearrayprop; - allows to assign a {datasource:datafield} to each of widestring arrays
 +
property integerfields: tdbfieldnamearrayprop; - allows to assign a {datasource:datafield} to each of integer arrays
 +
property floatfields: tdbfieldnamearrayprop; - allows to assign a {datasource:datafield} to each of real/datetime arrays
  
property taborderedwidgets: widgetarty read gettaborderedwidgets;
+
property optionsdb: lbdboptionsty; - tunes some DB behaviour apects
 +
- olbdb_closedataset :
 +
= once data obsolete, opens (if needed) the supplier dataset (disabling its bound controls)
 +
then [re]loads data from it then closes it
  
function findtagwidget(const atag: integer; const aclass: widgetclassty): twidget;
+
- olbdb_invalidateifmodified :
              //returns first matching descendent
+
= gets marked "invalid" once contents of the bound dataset change,
 +
it signals to reload the buffer with the new data just before next accessing
 +
( for any purpose - searching, lookuping, getting value/(array of values),..)
  
property container: twidget read getcontainer;
+
</pre>
function containeroffset: pointty;
 
function childrencount: integer; virtual;
 
property children[const index: integer]: twidget read getchildwidgets; default;
 
  
function childatpos(const pos: pointty;
+
=== TDBmemoLookupbuffer ===
                  const clientorigin: boolean = true): twidget; virtual;
+
<pre>
 +
- allows to use  for lookup-ing any text-convertable DB-fields
 +
- an analog of tdblookupbuffer, but :
 +
- "integerfields" may be names of any integer-convertable DB-fields
 +
- "floatfields" may be names of any (real/datetime)-convertable DB-fields
 +
- "textfields"  may be names of any text-presentable DB-fields
  
function getsortxchildren: widgetarty;
+
- each DB-field value ( presenting a memo generally of many lines ) may supply many data rows at once
function getsortychildren: widgetarty;
+
to the bound array of the buffer, since this value will be internally splitted & turned into native array values,
property focusedchild: twidget read ffocusedchild;
+
and the resulting "count" (arrays row count) of the whole buffer will be the minimal rows count amongst arrays
property focusedchildbefore: twidget read ffocusedchildbefore;
+
of the buffer, the rest data are truncated
  
function mouseeventwidget(const info: mouseeventinfoty): twidget;
+
- when loading widestring arrays, also checks for & performs "utf8-to-widestring" conversion of values of
 +
the bound DB-fields so that these arrays always store widestrings
 +
</pre>
  
function checkdescendent(widget: twidget): boolean;
+
=== TThreadComp ===
                    //true if widget is descendent or self
+
=== TStatFile ===
 +
<pre>
 +
- so that to be in effect, it should also be assigned to the form where the widget using the stafile is placed on
 +
- in design, if "onstatwrite" is set and "filedir" is not yet created, deactivate exception "ECreateError" in project settings ( "Debugger" tab )
 +
- "filedir" may contain "~/" indicating the user's home directory
 +
- options "oe_savestate" & "oe_savevalue" of "client" widgets define what to store to the file
 +
- position etc changes or/and value changes
 +
- in case when a main form shares its stafile with non-main forms, on creating non-main ones, just edited not saved data of the main form ( bound to vars of the statfile) are reset to values read from the statfile upon creating the form; for "sfo_memory", this effect absents unless widgets on the concurring forms share same variable[s]; to avoid this behaviour, disable "fo_autoreadstat" & "fo_autowritestat" of the non-main forms
 +
- each "tstafile" owns:
 +
= tstatwriter:
 +
* provides methods of writing sections & statvars to a memory/file stream
 +
- tstatreader:
 +
* holds list of sections with statvars each
 +
* provides search & check & reading interface to the statvars
 +
* provides reading statvars from a memory/file stream
  
function checkancestor(widget: twidget): boolean;
+
Positioning to a section speeds up accessing its statvars
                    //true if widget is ancestor or self
 
  
function containswidget(awidget: twidget): boolean;
+
- there also is "tstatfiler" ( exposed by some "tstatfile" events ) which:
 +
= may present or "tstatwriter" or "tstatreader" ( there's a check method )
 +
= provides directionless "update" methods with internal switch to needed direction of processing
 +
- "reading" or "writing" statvars on per-section basis
  
procedure insertwidget(const awidget: twidget); overload;
 
  
procedure insertwidget(const awidget: twidget; const apos: pointty); overload; virtual;
+
activator :
                //widget can be child
+
<see tactivator> : NOT YET DONE
  
function iswidgetclick(const info: mouseeventinfoty; const caption: boolean = false): boolean;
+
encoding = "en_utf8" selected here, allows to store non-Latin text in the file
//true if eventtype = et_butonrelease, button is mb_left, clicked and pos in clientrect
+
      filedir = directory where to keep the file ( by default - the current working directory )
//or in frame.caption if caption = true, origin = pos
+
filename = name of the file
  
function isclick(const info: mouseeventinfoty): boolean;
+
options:
//true if eventtype = et_butonrelease, button is mb_left, clicked and pos in clientrect
+
sfo_memory = reads & writes not from a disk file but from a named memory stream
 +
( there's an exclusion - see below "sfo_savedata" ),
 +
mostly useful for presenting last used values on recalling
 +
non-main forms etc ( data even survive recreating forms),
 +
or even for data "exchange" between non-main modal( non-concurring ) forms
 +
in case of the target widgets share same statvarnames
  
 +
sfo_createpath = creates "filedir" if necessary
 +
sfo_savedata = used only with "sfo_memory", commands to save
 +
the memory data to the master statfile (see below)
  
function isdblclick(const info: mouseeventinfoty): boolean;
+
sfo_activatorread = activator activate triggers reading ???
//true if eventtype = et_butonpress, button is mb_left, pos in clientrect
+
sfo_activatorwrite = activator deactivate triggers writing ???
// and timedlay to last buttonpress is short
 
  
function isdblclicked(const info: mouseeventinfoty): boolean;
+
statfile = a master statfile
//true if eventtype in [et_buttonpress,et_butonrelease], button is mb_left,
+
statvarname = name of section of this file in the upper statfile
// and timedlay to last same buttonevent is short
+
Tag = an integer property for misc purposes
  
function isleftbuttondown(const info: mouseeventinfoty): boolean;
+
Event handlers:
//true if eventtype = et_butonpress, button is mb_left, pos in clientrect
+
onstatafterread - fires on return from "readstat"
//origin = paintrect.pos
+
onstatafterwrite - fires on return from "writestat"
 +
onstatbeforeread - fires on beginning of "readstat"
 +
onstatbeforewrite - fires on beginning of "writestat"
 +
onstatread = fires after reading state data
 +
onstatwrite = fires after writing state data
 +
onstatupdate = fires after reading/writing state data just before
 +
"onstatread" & "onstatwrite"
  
//======================
+
Public methods:
  
widgetrect: the widget on-screen area including its frame & frame caption
+
  procedure initnewcomponent(const ascale: real); override;
 +
  - does nothing but fixes the default file name as the statfile default
 +
 
 +
  procedure readstat(stream: ttextstream = nil); overload;
 +
  - rereads all statvars of the stafile/memorystream
 +
 
 +
  procedure readstat(const aname: msestring; const statreader: tstatreader); overload;
 +
  - rereads "aname" statvar of the statfile
  
paintrect: the widget on-screen area except its frame & frame caption
+
  procedure writestat(const stream: ttextstream = nil); overload;
 +
  - rewrites all statvars to the stafile/memorystream
 +
  (if neccessary, prepares to writting - creates "filedir", stafile,...)
 +
 
 +
  procedure writestat(const aname: msestring; const statwriter: tstatwriter); overload;
 +
  - overwrites "aname" statvar of the statfile
 +
 
 +
  procedure updatestat(const aname: msestring; const statfiler: tstatfiler);
 +
  - depending on kind of "statfiler" ( writer/reader ), writes/reads
 +
    the most up-to-date stat data
 +
</pre>
  
clientrect: virtual area which
+
=== TTimer ===
- for non-scrolling widgets, equals to "paintrect", with its "pos:= (0,0)"
+
=== TNoGuiAction ===
- for scrolling widgets, may be bigger than "paintrect",
+
=== TPipeReadercomp ===
  also may shift ( change its "pos" ) when scrolling
+
=== TSysEnvManager ===
 +
=== TProcessMonitor ===
 +
=== TFilechangeNotifier ===
 +
=== TShortCutController ===
 +
=== TPostscriptPrinter ===
 +
=== TGdiPrinter ===
 +
=== TWmfPrinter ===
 +
=== TSkinController ===
 +
=== TGuiThreadComp ===
  
//======================
+
== Font ==
 +
See also : [[Reference:_MSEgui/TFont]]
  
 +
=== Any Font ===
 +
<pre>
 +
    charset { ANSI/ DEFAULT/ SYMBOL /SHIFTJIS /HANGEUL /GB2312 /CHINESEBIG5 /OEM
 +
/JOHAB / HEBREW/ ARABIC/ GREEK/ TURKISH/ VIETNAMESE/ THAI/ EASTEUROPE/
 +
RUSSIAN/ MAC/ BALTIC }
 +
- changes the font to the nearest containing the selected encoding(charset)
 +
- no font change made if the supplied encoding doesn't match any font
 +
color
 +
- color of the glyphs contours
 +
colorbackground
 +
- fill color of the glyph cells ( not including extraspace )
 +
colorshadow
 +
- color of SE glyph "edges" ( if not "cl_none", deactivates "colorbackground" )
 +
extraspace
 +
- v-space between glyph cells of adjacent text rows (negative values cause the cells to overlap )
 +
height
 +
- v-size of glyph cells, in pixels
 +
name
 +
- initially, font is choosen by { "family" = this name }
 +
options:
 +
foo_fixed
 +
- changes the font to the nearest "mono" spaced (usually = Courier)
 +
foo_proportional
 +
- changes the font to the nearest "proportionally" spaced (usually = Helvetica)
 +
foo_helvetica
 +
- changes the font to the nearest in "sans" category (usually = Helvetica)
 +
foo_roman
 +
- changes the font to the nearest in "serif" category (usually = Times[ New Roman])
 +
foo_script
 +
- Win32 only, changes the font to the nearest in "script" category
 +
foo_decorative
 +
- Win32 only, changes the font to the nearest in "decorative" category
 +
foo_antialiased
 +
- Linux-only, enables antialiasing (if disabled by Xft globally)
 +
foo_nonantialiased
 +
- Linux-only, disables antialiasing (if enabled by Xft globally)
 +
usually making glyph extents (not cells !) a bit wider
 +
style:
 +
fs_bold
 +
- gives the font a "bold" look
 +
fs_italic
 +
- gives the font an "italic" look
 +
fs_underline
 +
- gives the font an "underlined" look
 +
fs_strikeout
 +
- gives the font a "striked out" look
 +
fs_selected
 +
- "TRUE" here combined with {tf_noselect:=FALSE}, causes the text described by this font
 +
to be initially selected ( with the clipboard operations available ),
 +
currently applicable only to richstrings
  
 +
width
 +
- 10*{ glyph cell width, average in pixels }, 0 = {font default}
  
// the coord of outer top-left corner against the toplevel form = the window owner,
+
xscale
// including the frame & frame caption
+
- width ratio of each glyph {cell & contour}, the effect is similar to "width"
function rootpos: pointty;
 
 
 
// the coord of the outer top-left corner against the screen ( the WM decorations aren't counted in )
 
// includes the frame & frame caption
 
property screenpos: pointty;
 
 
 
//  the coord of the outer top-left corner against the parent widget,
 
// including the frame & frame caption
 
property widgetrect: rectty;
 
property pos: pointty; // =widgetrect.pos
 
property size: sizety; // =widgetrect.size
 
property left: integer; // =bounds_x
 
property right: integer; //widgetrect.x + widgetrect.cx, sets cx;
 
property top: integer;  // =bounds_y
 
property bottom: integer; //widgetrect.y + widgetrect.cy, sets cy;
 
property width: integer; // =bounds_cx
 
property height: integer; // =bounds_cy
 
function widgetsizerect: rectty;          //pos = nullpoint
 
 
 
    // the coord of the paint area ( paintrect ) against own outer top-left corner ( against "widgetrect=pos" )
 
    //  except the frame & frame caption
 
function paintrect: rectty;
 
function paintpos: pointty;
 
function paintsize: sizety;
 
function innerpaintrect: rectty; // mainly equals to paintrect
 
function clientwidgetrect: rectty; // mainly equals to paintrect
 
function clientwidgetpos: pointty;
 
function clippedpaintrect: rectty; // mainly equals to but clipped by all parentpaintrects
 
function innerwidgetrect: rectty;    // mainly equals to paintrect
 
function innerclientwidgetpos: pointty;
 
 
 
    // the coord of the paint area ( paintrect ) against own outer top-left corner ( against "widgetrect=pos" )
 
    //  except the frame caption
 
function framerect: rectty; // =paintrect except the frame caption area
 
function framepos: pointty;
 
function framesize: sizety;
 
  
    // the coord of the client area ( clientrect )  against the paint area ( paintrect )
+
*** "foo_*" font selection overrides one made with "name"
    //  usually these areas match
 
function clientrect: rectty;
 
property clientsize: sizety;
 
property clientwidth: integer;
 
property clientheight: integer;
 
property clientpos: pointty;
 
  
    // the coord of the paint area of the parent against the paint area of this widget
+
*** if change with "foo_*" is unsuccessful then the nearest "sans" font is usually chosen
function paintrectparent: rectty; //nullrect if parent = nil,
 
  
    // the coord of the client area of the parent against the paint area of this widget
+
*** The categories :
function clientrectparent: rectty; //nullrect if parent = nil,
 
  
// the coord of the inner area against the client area ( clientrect )
+
sans => have no serifs and have strokes of even thickness
function innerclientrect: rectty;  // mainly equals to clientrect
+
serif => have serifs at glyph contours and made up of strokes of varying thickness
function innerclientsize: sizety;
+
script => resemble handwriting
function innerclientpos: pointty;
+
decorative => flashy styles to be used sparingly in headlines or posters
  
function framewidth: sizety;              //widgetrect.size - paintrect.size
+
</pre>
function clientframewidth: sizety;        //widgetrect.size - clientrect.size
 
function innerclientframewidth: sizety;  //widgetrect.size - innerclientrect.size
 
function innerframewidth: sizety;        //clientrect.size - innerclientrect.size 
 
  
    // the coord of the paint area against the widgetrect(pos) of the parent
+
== GUI ==
function paintparentpos: pointty;    //origin = parentwidget.pos
+
=== TWindow ===
 +
<pre>
 +
twindow = class(teventobject,icanvas)
 +
  public
  
    // the coord of the client area against the widgetrect(pos) of the parent
+
// releases mouse, unlinks from the canvas, processes all pending events of the window
function clientparentpos: pointty;  //origin = parentwidget.pos
+
// if called from within main thread then destroys the window directly
 +
// otherwise posts a window destroy event for oneself and waits for it to be processed
 +
procedure destroywindow;
  
    // the coord of the widgetrect(pos) against the client area of parent
+
// registers the instance of onself in the "owner" widget, allocates the canvas,
property parentclientpos: pointty;
+
// adds a reference to oneself,
 +
// then prepares the "owner" hierarchy to be invalidated ( "owner.rootchanged" )
 +
// since now, the window is allocated and belongs to the "aowner" widget
 +
constructor create(aowner: twidget);
  
 +
destructor destroy; override;
  
function clientpostowidgetpos(const apos: pointty): pointty;
+
// adds "method" to the internal list of scroll dependants
function widgetpostoclientpos(const apos: pointty): pointty;
+
procedure registeronscroll(const method: notifyeventty);
function widgetpostopaintpos(const apos: pointty): pointty;
 
function paintpostowidgetpos(const apos: pointty): pointty;
 
procedure scale(const ascale: real); virtual;
 
  
 +
// removes "method" from the internal list of scroll dependants
 +
procedure unregisteronscroll(const method: notifyeventty);
  
property minsize: sizety read fminsize write setminsize;
+
// releases mouse if captured, resets the cursor, then enters an event loop for the window,
property maxsize: sizety read fmaxsize write setmaxsize;
+
// TRUE on return if the window is destroyed
function maxclientsize: sizety; virtual;
+
function beginmodal: boolean;
 +
 +
  * checks if the "sender" window is already modal to avoid circularity,
 +
    if not then starts an event loop  for the "sender" where the "sender" is a receiver of GUI events,
 +
      once the loop is terminated reactivates the previously active window if it was,
 +
    TRUE if modalwindow destroyed 
  
 +
  function tinternalapplication.beginmodal(const sender: twindow): boolean;
  
property anchors: anchorsty read fanchors write setanchors default defaultanchors;
+
// removes the internal stuff which indicates the modal state
property defaultfocuschild: twidget read getdefaultfocuschild write setdefaultfocuschild;
+
procedure endmodal;
  
 +
// if the window is visible,
 +
// deactivates the previously active window, shows the window (see below),
 +
// if no active window in the app or the window or its Z-predecessor is modal and
 +
// the app has no focused widget then prepares the bound widget to be focused,
 +
// then addresses the WM to put the window to foreground
 +
procedure activate;
  
procedure changeclientsize(const delta: sizety); //asynchronous
+
  // if the bound widget has visible=true then:
 +
  //  - if NOT windowevent then :
 +
  //    = address the WM to set size of the window acc to window opts
 +
  //      wp_maximized, wp_fullscreen or normal size otherwise
 +
  // = if the window is normally sized, moves it to its default position is specified ( screen centered etc )
 +
  // - unhides/unminimizes the window if needed
 +
  // - shows other windows of the applications acc to state of the window group
 +
  // ( in normal size or minimized )
  
function getcanvas(aorigin: originty = org_client): tcanvas;
+
  private
 +
procedure twindow.show(windowevent: boolean);
  
function showing: boolean;
+
// TRUE if this window currently grabs user input
              //true if self and all ancestors visible and window allocated
+
( a widget drawn within the window(=form) is in focus,.. )
 +
function active: boolean;
  
function isenabled: boolean;
+
// if the window was active then deactivates the window  & remembers it as the previous active ( to restore leater if requested ),
              //true if self and all ancestors enabled
+
// returns TRUE if that storage occurred
 +
function deactivateintermediate: boolean;  
  
function active: boolean;
+
// makes the window active & clears the above app reference to it ( "active before deactivating" )
function entered: boolean;
+
procedure reactivate; //clears app.finactivewindow
  
function activeentered: boolean;
+
// scans the app event queue for "ek_expose" event[s] addressed to the window,
//true if entered and window is regularactivewindow or inactivated
+
// if found then redraws that part of the window which the event describes
 +
// ( processed events are then deleted )
 +
procedure update;
  
function focused: boolean;
+
// TRUE if the window :
function clicked: boolean;
+
// 1) doesn't have an inner widget grabbing input focus
 +
// or
 +
// 2) has such widget, and this widget ( and all its descendants )
 +
//    pass "CanClose" check
 +
//
 +
// *** see also "twidget.CanClose" ***
 +
//
 +
function candefocus: boolean;
  
function indexofwidget(const awidget: twidget): integer;
+
// tries to defocus the currently focused widget if it belongs to the window,
 +
// if succeeds then executes code of virtual "DoDefocus" of the widget descessor
 +
// ( this code defines behaviour & look of the widget on defocusing );
 +
//
 +
// no defocusing is done if the focused widget ( or its descendants )
 +
// doesn't pass "CanClose" check
 +
//
 +
procedure nofocus;
 +
 
 +
  // setfocusedwidget(widget)
 +
 
 +
  property focuscount: cardinal read ffocuscount;
 +
  function close: boolean; //true if ok
 +
  procedure beginmoving; //lock window rect modification
 +
  procedure endmoving;
 +
  procedure bringtofront;
 +
  procedure sendtoback;
 +
  procedure stackunder(const predecessor: twindow);
 +
      //stacking is performed in mainloop idle, nil means top
 +
  procedure stackover(const predecessor: twindow);
 +
      //stacking is performed in mainloop idle, nil means bottom
 +
  function stackedunder: twindow; //nil if top
 +
  function stackedover: twindow;  //nil if bottom
 +
  function hastransientfor: boolean;
  
procedure changedirection(const avalue: graphicdirectionty;
+
  procedure capturemouse;
                                            var dest: graphicdirectionty); virtual;
+
  procedure releasemouse;
 +
  procedure postkeyevent(const akey: keyty;  
 +
        const ashiftstate: shiftstatesty = []; const release: boolean = false;
 +
                  const achars: msestring = '');
  
// (re)arranges "awidgets" horizontally within the parent's client area
+
  function winid: winidty;
// so that awidget[i] were placed next each other
+
  function haswinid: boolean;
// at h-space dist[i], starting from "startx" with the right margin "endmargin";
+
  function state: windowstatesty;
//
+
  function visible: boolean;
// if the number of "dist" is fewer than the number of "awidgets" then the remaining h-spaces are taken
+
  function activating: boolean; //in internalactivate proc
// as the last "dist[i]" or "0" if none;
+
  function normalwindowrect: rectty;
// if the number of "dist" is more than the number of "awidgets" then the extra dist[i] are discarded
+
  property updateregion: regionty read fupdateregion;
//
+
  function updaterect: rectty;
// non-zero "endmargin" causes one of awdidget[i] to h-resize to provide the margin :
+
 
//  - if one or more of awidgets[i] have [an_left,an_right] set then the first of such is resized
+
  procedure registermovenotification(sender: iobjectlink);
//   otherwise the last awidgets[i] is h-resized
+
  procedure unregistermovenotification(sender: iobjectlink);
//
+
 
procedure placexorder(
+
  property options: windowoptionsty read foptions;
const startx: integer;  
+
 
const dist: array of integer;
+
// widget
                const awidgets: array of twidget;
+
property owner: twidget read fowner;
                const endmargin: integer = minint);
+
 
 +
  property focusedwidget: twidget read ffocusedwidget;
 +
  property transientfor: twindow read ftransientfor;
 +
  property modalresult: modalresultty read fmodalresult write setmodalresult;
 +
   property buttonendmodal: boolean read getbuttonendmodal write setbuttonendmodal;
 +
  property globalshortcuts: boolean read getglobalshortcuts write setglobalshortcuts;
 +
  property localshortcuts: boolean read getlocalshortcuts write setlocalshortcuts;
 +
  property windowpos: windowposty read getwindowpos write setwindowpos;
 +
  property caption: msestring read fcaption write setcaption;
  
// (re)arranges "awidgets" vertically within the parent's client area
 
// so that awidget[i] were placed upper/lower each other
 
// at v-space dist[i], starting from "starty" with the bottom margin "endmargin";
 
//
 
// if the number of "dist" is fewer than the number of "awidgets" then the remaining v-spaces are taken
 
// as the last "dist[i]" or "0" if none;
 
// if the number of "dist" is more than the number of "awidgets" then the extra dist[i] are discarded
 
//
 
// non-zero "endmargin" causes one of awdidget[i] to v-resize to provide the margin :
 
//  - if one or more of awidgets[i] have [an_top,an_bottom] set then the first of such is resized
 
//    otherwise the last awidgets[i] is v-resized
 
//
 
procedure placeyorder(
 
const starty: integer;
 
const dist: array of integer;
 
                const awidgets: array of twidget;
 
                const endmargin: integer = minint);
 
              //origin = clientpos, endmargin by size adjust of widgets
 
              //with [an_top,an_bottom], minint -> no change
 
  
// if {mode <> wam_none} then (re)arranges "awidgets" horizontally within the parent's client area so that
+
  windowoptionty = (wo_popup,wo_message,wo_buttonendmodal,wo_groupleader,
// awidgets[0] stays on its place but awidgets[1..N] :
+
                  wo_windowcentermessage); //showmessage centered in window
// - if {mode = wam_end} then awidgets[i>=1] move or resize ( if "anchors.al_left" set ) so that they right borders match the right border of awidgets[0]
 
// - if {mode = wam_start} then awidgets[i>=1] move or resize ( if "anchors.al_right" set ) so that they left borders match the left border of awidgets[0]
 
// - if {mode = wam_center} then awidgets[i>=1] move so that they Y-axes match the Y-axe of awidgets[0]
 
//
 
// mainly applicable for v-stacked widgets since h-stacked may overlap after such alignment
 
//
 
        // returns the reference point ( the coord of awidgets[0] )
 
function alignx(const mode: widgetalignmodety;
 
                        const awidgets: array of twidget): integer;
 
  
  
// if {mode <> wam_none} then (re)arranges "awidgets" vertically within the parent's client area so that
+
optionswindow:
// awidgets[0] stays on its place but awidgets[1..N] :  
+
wo_popup
// - if {mode = wam_end} then awidgets[i>=1] move or resize ( if "anchors.al_top" set ) so that they bottom borders match the bottom border of awidgets[0]
+
- in run-time, hides all OS windows-manager ( WM ) decorations (title bar, buttons "Close/Resize,Min/Max" etc),
// - if {mode = wam_start} then awidgets[i>=1] move or resize ( if "anchors.al_bottom" set ) so that they top borders match the top border of awidgets[0]
+
letting only its client area to appear
// - if {mode = wam_center} then awidgets[i>=1] move so that they X-axes match the X-axe of awidgets[0]
+
so :
//
+
= the window should have own facilities to replace the deactivated WM functionality if needed
// mainly applicable for h-stacked widgets since v-stacked may overlap after such alignment
+
= can't be resized/maximize/minimized/moved
//
+
wo_message
        // returns the reference point ( the coord of awidgets[0] )
+
- similar to "wo_popup" but allows WM to close ( with "Close" button ) & move the window
function aligny(const mode: widgetalignmodety;
 
                        const awidgets: array of twidget): integer;
 
 
 
function actualcursor: cursorshapety; virtual;
 
  
 +
wo_groupleader
 +
- keeps on the WM taskbar a shortcut to the window
 +
( if the parent window is a groupleader too then displays a step upper in its group )
  
 
Event handlers:
 
Event handlers:
  
- onactivate
+
- onmove
 +
= fires once the (window/widget) is created/moved ( with check if really moved by a distance)
  
fires :
+
</pre>
  
= on receiving input focus, just before "OnFocus"
+
=== TFormScrollbox ===
+
<pre>
= forms specific :
+
- presents client area of form & parent of its widgets,  
* on 1-st display of the form after "OnLoaded" ( from "Loaded" procedure)
+
initially stretched to fit the form & bound with anchoring
* on switch back from another apllication/WM ( "oe_activate" event )
+
but may be adjusted with "bounds" & "anchors"
* after closure of a descendant form
+
 
* on minimizing/maximizing the form
+
    Properties:
 +
               
 +
anchors
 +
bounds
 +
 +
color
 +
- color of the whole container area ( except its frame ) & form widgets
 +
if their color is "cl_parent"
  
- onchildscaled
+
name = container
  
fires :
+
cursor, enabled, face, frame, helpcontext, hint, optionswidget, popupmenu,
 +
taborder, tag, visible, onactivate, onafterpaint, onbeforepaint,
 +
onchildmouseevent, onclientmouseevent, ondeativate, ondefocus, onenter,
 +
onexit, onfocus, onfontheightdelta, onmouseevent, onpaint, onpopup
 +
onresize, onshowhint
 +
- the same meaning as for the served form
  
= on child(s) resizing due to font height change
 
  
= form widget: once "form.container" {scrolling widget} is loaded
+
oncalcminscrollsize
 +
onscroll
 +
onchildscaled
 +
</pre>
  
- ondeactivate
+
=== TFaceList ===
fires
+
=== TFrameComp ===
= form widget: when the form looses input focus
 
= non-form widget: when the widget looses input focus
 
  
- ondefocus
+
See also here: [[Reference:_MSEgui/TFrame]].
  
fires
+
= on disabling the widget
+
<pre>
 +
Terminology :
  
*mse = form widget: if another form is focused
+
{client area = area of the widget which interacts with a user}
= non-form widget: if another widget is focused
 
  
- onenter
+
{bevelling = additional facets rising/sinking frame & client area,
= fires on any way of taking parent-wide focus as soon as
+
constists of two parts -
the parent stores the new child's order, before "OnActivate" & "OnFocus"
+
- external: between frame and widget
 +
- internal: between frame and client area
 +
}
  
- onexit
+
{frame= flat space between external & internal facets,
= fires last on parent-wide lossing focus, after "OnDefocus" & "OnDeactivate"
+
floats at the inner level of the external facet
= for top-level ( not in a container ) forms, doesn't fire
+
}
  
- onfocus
+
*** Both frame & bevelling affect the client area ***
fires
 
= once the existing widget takes the focus
 
= on showing the widget's form if the widget has the lowest "TabOrder"
 
  
- onfontheightdelta
+
--------------------------
fires
+
template:
= if [ow_fontglyphheight OR ow_fontlineheight ] AND {the
 
new font height differs from the previos one}
 
= before the parent redraws this widget
 
  
- onpopup
+
colorclient = color of the client area
fires :
 
= on calling a popup-menu ( with "RightClick" ), once the menu items of the current level are loaded
 
( before building the submenus )
 
  
- onresize
+
colorframe = color of the frame
 +
colorframeactive = used instead of colorframe if the widget is
 +
active; "cl_default" means same as colorframe.
  
= fires on creating/(changing size)/(min-max restoring) of widget,
+
works if (leveli/levelo <> 0 that's the facets exist :
before actual redrawing
 
  
= rechecks if there's real work to do
+
colorshadow = color of facets screened from the NW light source
 +
colordkshadow = color of shadows dropped by the NW light source
 +
                colordkwidth = width of the shadows in pixel, -1=default
  
- onshowhint
+
colorlight = color of facets exposed to the NW light source
= fires when a installed hint is activated or on "aplication.showint" called
+
colorhighlight = color of brighter edges of the facets
= since called last, allows to adjust the default behavior
+
                colorhlwidth = width of the brighter edges in pixel, -1=default
  
- onbeforeupdateskin
+
        extraspace = if applied to menu items, adds more space between these items
= fires in "updateskin" ( the widget is loaded etc ) before applying the skin
 
  
- onafterupdateskin
+
framei_:
= fires in "updateskin" ( the widget is loaded etc ) once the skin is applied
+
(for extendable widgets like menus, these settings widen the widget,
 +
for non-extendable like buttons - they squeeze the text area )
  
<pre/>
+
bottom= lower margin of text to the client area
 +
left = left margin of text to the client area
 +
right = margin of text to the client area
 +
top = upper margin of text to the client area
  
== NoGui ==
+
framewidth= width of the frame
=== TAction ===
+
leveli = {width=height} of the internal facet, positive -> raised, negative -> sunken
<pre>
+
levelo = {width=height} of the external facet, positive -> raised, negative -> sunken
Shortcut processing order :
 
  
- the smallest piece of processing is "doshortcut" procedure which
+
<any frame>
is called until processed:
 
= starting from the sender up to the toplevel widget
 
= then by all child widgets with non-set "ow_noparentshortcut"
 
= then, if "ow_nochildshortcut" isn't set, by the parent widget
 
= then by the widget oneself
 
 
- "doshortcut" is checked in the following order:
 
= starting from form's main menu
 
= then from the owning window ( the widget oneself )
 
= then from the application
 
  
 +
*** extends & customizes "tframecomp" ***
  
*** A shortcut is bound to a widget by :
+
template
- placing an action component on the widget ***
+
- "tframecomp" supplying the initial settings
- direct assigning the shortcut to the widget (menus,..)
+
 
---------------------------
+
colorclient,colordkshadow,colordkwidth,colorframe,colorframeactive,
 +
colorhighlight,colorhlwidth,colorlight,colorshadow,framewidth,  
 +
leveli, levelo, framei_*,
  
caption, color, colorglyph, helpcontext, hint, imagecheckedoffset,
+
<see "tframecomp">
imagelist <see "timagelist">, imagenr, imagenrdisabled
 
  
- sets look of "clients" (buttons, menu/toolbar items,..), unless
+
font
these clients have "state.as_local*" set :
+
<see "tfont">
  
*** For meaning of these options, see help on the "client" widgets ***
+
caption
 +
- some descriptive text( function name, user prompt,...) placed
 +
in a N/W/S/E-combination to the widget's client area
  
group
+
***
- default value for one-named property of the bound widgets
+
non-empty caption if (captionpos <> cp_center) & (captiondistouter=false & captiondist>0) enlarges the framed widget
( menu items,... )
+
by the corresponding size of caption
  
options :
+
***
ao_updateonidle
 
- runs this action in cycle, waiting for no gui events everytime
 
  
ao_globalshortcut
+
captiondist - margin between the caption & the client area
- allows the action to trigger on a non-main form
 
  (the shortcut is triggered whatever form of the applicatin it was pressed on,
 
  otherwise only when the form where the aption is placed on is focused )
 
  
ao_nocandefocus
+
captiondistouter :
- causes the action not to call "CanDefocus" for focused edit widget of active form
 
  before executing own code
 
  ( it helps to avoid the effect of cancelling changes in these widgets
 
  on activating the bound shortcut )
 
  
shortcut
+
- if "false"(by default), the distance is measured between
- keyboard combination triggering the action
+
the inner (facing the client area) extent of the caption
 +
and the client area outward the area,
 +
the caption is placed outside of the client area
  
shortcut
+
- if "true", the caption is mirrored against the edge of client area as
- alternative "shortcut" and handled identically
+
to the position when "false"
  
state :
+
*** nagative values of "captiondist" visually inverse "out of" and within ***
  
as_disabled
+
      captionnoclip - do not clip frame and client area for caption background
- prevents the action from triggering, also puts the bound widgets to "disabled" look
+
( the client area preserves own background under the caption text)
  
as_invisible
+
captionnooffset - shift orthogonal to "captiondist"
- in run-time, hides the bound widget, still reacting on the shortcut or direct call
 
  
as_checked
+
captionpos - "corner" where to place the caption
- selects the bound menu item if it has "mao_checkbox" option set
 
  
as_default
+
localprops :
as_local*
 
  
statfile
+
frl_levelo - "levelo" overrides "template.levelo"
<see "tstatfile">
+
frl_leveli - "leveli" overrides "template.leveli"
 +
frl_framewidth - "framewidth" overrides "template.framewidth"
 +
frl_colorclient - "colorclient" overrides "template.colorclient"
 +
frl_colorframe - "colorframe" overrides "template.colorframe"
 +
frl_colorframeactive - "colorframeactive" overrides "template.colorframeactive"
 +
frl_colordkshadow - "colordkshadow" overrides "template.colordkshadow"
 +
frl_colorshadow - "colorshadow" overrides "template.colorshadow"
 +
frl_colorlight - "colorlight" overrides "template.colorlight"
 +
frl_colorhighlight - "colorhighlight" overrides "template.colorhighlight"
 +
frl_colordkwidth - "colordkwidth" overrides "template.colordkwidth"
 +
frl_colorhlwidth - "colorhlwidth" overrides "template.colorhlwidth"
 +
frl_fileft - "framei_left" overrides "template.framei_left"
 +
frl_firight - "framei_right" overrides "template.framei_right"
 +
frl_fitop - "framei_top" overrides "template.framei_top"
 +
frl_fibottom - "framei_bottom" overrides "template.framei_bottom"
  
stavarname
+
frl_nodisable
 +
</pre>
 +
 
 +
=== TFaceComp ===
 +
 
 +
See also here: https://wiki.freepascal.org/Reference:_MSEgui/TFace
 +
 
 +
<pre>
 +
- doesn't affect the widget frame but client area of the frame
  
 
tagaction
 
onasyncevent
 
onchange
 
onexecute
 
onupdate
 
<pre/>
 
  
=== TActivator ===
+
template:
=== TThreadComp ===
+
fade:
=== TStatFile ===
+
color[i]: = colors forming the fade
- so that to be in effect, it should also be assigned to the form where the widget using the stafile is placed on
+
direction: = direction where the fade grows to
- in design, if "onstatwrite" is set and "filedir" is not yet created, deactivate exception "ECreateError" in project settings ( "Debugger" tab )
+
gd_(right/up/left/down)
- "filedir" may contain "~/" indicating the user's home directory
+
 
- options "oe_savestate" & "oe_savevalue" of "client" widgets define what to store to the file
+
pos[i]: = relational position of color[i] on the direction (0.0..1.0) extent
- position etc changes or/and value changes
+
 
- in case when a main form shares its stafile with non-main forms, on creating non-main ones, just edited not saved data of the main form ( bound to vars of the statfile) are reset to values read from the statfile upon creating the form; for "sfo_memory", this effect absents unless widgets on the concurring forms share same variable[s]; to avoid this behaviour, disable "fo_autoreadstat" & "fo_autowritestat" of the non-main forms
+
transparency = makes the face half-transparent and enlighten the underlying widget 
- each "tstafile" owns:
+
with a light source of the selected color
= tstatwriter:
+
( in this case, colors of the face & the widget & the light source
* provides methods of writing sections & statvars to a memory/file stream
+
simply summarize to higher brightness )
- tstatreader:
 
* holds list of sections with statvars each
 
* provides search & check & reading interface to the statvars
 
* provides reading statvars from a memory/file stream
 
  
Positioning to a section speeds up accessing its statvars
+
image:
 +
see <any image>
  
- there also is "tstatfiler" ( exposed by some "tstatfile" events ) which:
+
options:
= may present or "tstatwriter" or "tstatreader" ( there's a check method )
 
= provides directionless "update" methods with internal switch to needed direction of processing
 
- "reading" or "writing" statvars on per-section basis
 
  
=== TTimer ===
+
        *** The fade colors are used not as colors but RGB alpha values ($00 -> opaque, $ff -> transparent)
=== TNoGuiAction ===
+
if fao_alpha* are set *** :
=== TPipeReadercomp ===
+
 
=== TSysEnvManager ===
+
fao_alphafadeall = applies blending to the widget & all its children
=== TProcessMonitor ===
+
fao_alphafadenochildren = preserves child widgets from blending
=== TFilechangeNotifier ===
+
                fao_alphafadeimage = applies blending to "face.image"
=== TShortCutController ===
+
 
=== TPostscriptPrinter ===
+
 
=== TGdiPrinter ===
+
<any face>
=== TWmfPrinter ===
+
 
=== TSkinController ===
+
*** extends & customizes "tfacecomp" ***
=== TGuiThreadComp ===
+
 
 +
fade, image, option
 +
- see "tfacecomp"
 +
 +
template
 +
- "tfacecomp" supplying the initial settings
 +
 
 +
localprops :
 +
fal_options - "options" overrides "template.options"
 +
fal_fadirection - "fade.direction" overrides "template.fade.direction"
 +
fal_image - "image" overrides "template.image"
 +
fal_fapos - "fade.pos[i]" overrides "template.fade.pos[i]"
 +
fal_facolor - "fade.color[i]" overrides "template.fade.color[i]"
 +
fal_fatransparency - "fade.transparency" overrides "template.fade.transparency"
 +
</pre>
  
== Font ==
+
=== TBitmapComp ===
=== Any Font ===
+
=== TScalingwidget ===
 
<pre>
 
<pre>
    charset { ANSI/ DEFAULT/ SYMBOL /SHIFTJIS /HANGEUL /GB2312 /CHINESEBIG5 /OEM
+
  optionsscale :
/JOHAB / HEBREW/ ARABIC/ GREEK/ TURKISH/ VIETNAMESE/ THAI/ EASTEUROPE/
+
autosizing to provide room for :
RUSSIAN/ MAC/ BALTIC }
+
= {"frame.caption" + "offset_*"}
- changes the font to the nearest containing the selected encoding(charset)
+
= "offset_*" if "frame.caption" is unset and "osc_shrink*" is set
- no font change made if the supplied encoding doesn't match any font
+
color
+
= osc_expandx
- color of the glyphs contours
+
- makes the widget wider to fit the caption if needed
colorbackground
+
 
- fill color of the glyph cells ( not including extraspace )
+
= osc_shrinkx
colorshadow
+
- makes the widget narrower to have no space left & right to the "frame.caption"
- color of SE glyph "edges" ( if not "cl_none", deactivates "colorbackground" )
+
 
extraspace
+
= osc_expandy
- v-space between glyph cells of adjacent text rows (negative values cause the cells to overlap )
+
- makes the widget taller to fit the caption if needed
height
+
 
- v-size of glyph cells, in pixels
+
= osc_shrinky
name
+
- makes the widget lower to have no space up & down to the "frame.caption"
- initially, font is choosen by { "family" = this name }
+
 
options:
+
= osc_invisishrinkx
foo_fixed
+
- fully h-collapses if "visible=false" ( run-time only )
- changes the font to the nearest "mono" spaced (usually = Courier)
+
 
foo_proportional
+
= osc_invisishrinky
- changes the font to the nearest "proportionally" spaced (usually = Helvetica)
+
- fully v-collapses if "visible=false" ( run-time only )
foo_helvetica
+
 
- changes the font to the nearest in "sans" category (usually = Helvetica)
+
</pre>
foo_roman
+
 
- changes the font to the nearest in "serif" category (usually = Times[ New Roman])
+
=== TImageList ===
foo_script
+
=== TPopupMenu ===
- Win32 only, changes the font to the nearest in "script" category
+
=== TMainMenu ===
foo_decorative
+
 
- Win32 only, changes the font to the nearest in "decorative" category
+
== Dialog ==
foo_antialiased
+
=== TFileListview ===
- Linux-only, enables antialiasing (if disabled by Xft globally)
+
=== TFileDialog ===
foo_nonantialiased
+
=== TFaceComp ===
- Linux-only, disables antialiasing (if enabled by Xft globally)
+
=== TFileNameEdit ===
usually making glyph extents (not cells !) a bit wider
+
=== TDirDropdownEdit ===
style:
+
=== TColorEdit ===
fs_bold
+
=== TMemoDialogEdit ===
- gives the font a "bold" look
+
=== TPageSizeSelector ===
fs_italic
+
=== TPageOrientationSelector ===
- gives the font an "italic" look
 
fs_underline
 
- gives the font an "underlined" look
 
fs_strikeout
 
- gives the font a "striked out" look
 
fs_selected
 
- "TRUE" here combined with {tf_noselect:=FALSE}, causes the text described by this font
 
to be initially selected ( with the clipboard operations available ),
 
currently applicable only to richstrings
 
  
width
+
== Application ==
- 10*{ glyph cell width, average in pixels }, 0 = {font default}
+
=== TGuiApplication ===
 +
<pre>
 +
tguiapplication = class(tcustomapplication)
 +
  public
  
xscale
+
  // [re]starts the system timer with the new period and
- width ratio of each glyph {cell & contour}, the effect is similar to "width"
+
  // subscribes the application to be a receiver of the modified "ek_timer" event
 +
  // ( can check for it in the event queue )
 +
  procedure settimer(const us: integer);
  
*** "foo_*" font selection overrides one made with "name"
+
  // finds a window by its winID
 +
  function findwindow(id: winidty; out window: twindow): boolean;
  
*** if change with "foo_*" is usuccessful then the nearest "sans" font is usually choosen
+
  // finds a window by its ID & adjusts "rect" so that it
 +
  // fits "bounds_minc*" & "bounds_maxc*" of the found window
 +
  procedure checkwindowrect(winid: winidty; var rect: rectty);
  
*** The categories :
+
  // initialises the timer and "megraphics"
 +
  procedure initialize;
  
sans => have no serifs and have strokes of even thickness
+
  // frees the allocated system resources (GDI, event subscription, the timer)
serif => have serifs at glyph contours and made up of strokes of varying thickness
+
  procedure deinitialize;
script => resemble handwriting
 
decorative => flashy styles to be used sparingly in headlines or posters
 
  
<pre/>
+
  // creates a form instance, it will be shown in "application.run"
 +
  procedure createform(instanceclass: widgetclassty; var reference);
  
== GUI ==
+
  // invalidates all registered forms ( all their widgets will be redrawn )
=== TWindow ===
+
  procedure invalidate;
<pre>
+
 
twindow = class(teventobject,icanvas)
+
  // calls a nested main event loop, forces processing any pending messages,
  public
+
  procedure processmessages; override; //handle with care!
  
// releases mouse, unlinks from the canvas, processes all pending events of the window
+
  // TRUE if no pending events to process for the application
// if called from within main thead then destroys the window directly
+
  function idle: boolean; override;
// otherwise posts a window destroy event for oneself and waits for it to be processed
+
 
procedure destroywindow;
+
  // requests to indicate waiting ( to show the "watches" cursors )
 +
  procedure beginwait; override;
  
// registers the instance of onself in the "owner" widget, allocates the canvas,
+
  // removes the "watches" if no unclosed requests for displaying them,
// adds a reference to oneself,
+
  // otherwise closes the currently active request
// then prepares the "owner" hierarchy to be invalidated ( "owner.rootchanged" )
+
  procedure endwait; override;
// since now, the window is allocated and belongs to the "aowner" widget
 
constructor create(aowner: twidget);
 
  
destructor destroy; override;
+
  // TRUE if there are unclosed requests for displaying "watches"
 +
  function waiting: boolean;
  
// adds "method" to the internal list of scroll dependants
+
  // TRUE if ESC has just been pressed
procedure registeronscroll(const method: notifyeventty);
+
  //  - if all requests for displaying "watches" are closed then refreshes
 +
  //    the internal list of events ( the GUI-queue -> the app event list)
 +
  function waitescaped: boolean; //true if escape pressed while waiting
  
// removes "method" from the internal list of scroll dependants
+
  // sets state of the current wait dialogue ( but doesn't close one ) to undefined
procedure unregisteronscroll(const method: notifyeventty);
+
  procedure resetwaitdialog;  
  
// releases mouse if captured, resets the cursor, then enters an event loop for the window,
+
  // runs "aexecuteaction" in the main thread in OnIdle mode,
// TRUE on return if the window is destroyed
+
  // then shows a cancellable message,
function beginmodal: boolean;
+
  // if the one is cancelled then runs "acancelaction" then
+
  // either fully clears (if exceptions occur )
  * checks if the "sender" window is already modal to avoid circularity,  
+
  // or terminates the execution otherwise,
    if not then starts an event loop  for the "sender" where the "sender" is a receiver of GUI events,
+
  // true if not cancelled;
      once the loop is terminated reactivates the previously active window if it was,
+
  // "application.processmessages" must be called regularly if "aexecuteaction" is used here,
    TRUE if modalwindow destroyed 
+
  // alternatively "aidleaction" can be used, call sleep ( some time ) in order to minimize
 +
  // processor load.
 +
  // If athread <> nil the function starts and terminates the thread   
 +
  function waitdialog(const athread: tthreadcomp = nil; const atext: msestring = '';
 +
                  const caption: msestring = '';
 +
                  const acancelaction: notifyeventty = nil;
 +
                  const aexecuteaction: notifyeventty = nil): boolean; override;
  
  function tinternalapplication.beginmodal(const sender: twindow): boolean;
+
  // closes the currently modal waitdialogue with "cancelled" state
 +
  procedure cancelwait;
  
// removes the internal stuff which indicates the modal state
+
  // closes the currently modal waitdialogue with "ok" state
procedure endmodal;
+
  procedure terminatewait;
  
// if the window is visible,
+
  function waitstarted: boolean;  // the last waitdialogue is currently showing for some requests
// deactivates the previously active window, shows the window (see below),
+
  function waitcanceled: boolean;  // the last waitdialogue has been cancelled for some request (but can be shown fot others ?)
// if no active window in the app or the window or its Z-predescessor is modal and
+
  function waitterminated: boolean; // the last waitdialogue has been terminated for some request (but can be shown fot others ?)
// the app has no focused widget then prepares the bound widget to be focused,
 
// then addresses the WM to put the window to foreground
 
procedure activate;
 
  
  // if the bound widget has visible=true then:
+
  // if called from the main app thread then shows as a modal message describing the exception
  //  - if NOT windowevent then :
+
   // otherwise posts an async event for which the message will be called
  //   = address the WM to set size of the window acc to window opts
+
  procedure showexception(e: exception; const leadingtext: string = ''); override;
  //     wp_maximized, wp_fullscreen or normal size otherwise
 
  // = if the window is normally sized, moves it to its default position is specified ( screen centered etc )
 
  // - unhides/unminimizes the window if needed
 
  // - shows other windows of the applications acc to state of the window group
 
  // ( in normal size or minimized )
 
  
  private
+
  // posts an async event for which the message describing the exception will be called
procedure twindow.show(windowevent: boolean);
+
  procedure showasyncexception(e: exception; const leadingtext: string = '');
  
// TRUE if this window currently grabs user input
+
  // "application.errormessage" shows standard error message ( with "ERROR" title )  
( a widget drawn within the window(=form) is in focus,.. )
+
  procedure errormessage(const amessage: msestring); override;
function active: boolean;
 
  
// if the window was active then deactivates the window  & remembers it as the previous active ( to restore leater if requested ),
+
  // [re]calculates timings & position of hint for "ahintedwidget"
// returns TRUE if that storage occured
+
  // if "ow_timedhint" in "ahintedwidget.foptionswidget" then iys showtime will be
function deactivateintermediate: boolean;  
+
  // "defaulthintshowtime" ( an app wide setting, 3sec by default) 
 +
  procedure inithintinfo(var info: hintinfoty; const ahintedwidget: twidget);
  
// makes the window active & clears the above app reference to it ( "active before deactivating" )
 
procedure reactivate; //clears app.finactivewindow
 
  
// scans the app event queue for "ek_expose" event[s] addressed to the window,
+
  // shows the supplied hint text within "aposrect" with alignment "aplacement" during "ashowtime",
// if found then redraws that part of the window which the event describes
+
  // the avail ( but not used currenly ) flags are : hfl_show,hfl_custom,hfl_noautohidemove,hfl_noautohidemove 
// ( processed events are then deleted )
+
  procedure showhint(const sender: twidget; const hint: msestring;
procedure update;
+
              const aposrect: rectty; const aplacement: captionposty = cp_bottomleft;
 +
              const ashowtime: integer = defaulthintshowtime; //0 -> inifinite,
 +
                // -1 defaultshowtime if ow_timedhint in sender.optionswidget
 +
              const aflags: hintflagsty = defaulthintflags
 +
                      ); overload;
  
// TRUE if the window :
+
  // shows the supplied hint text at left-top position"apos" during "ashowtime",
// 1) doesn't have an inner widget grabbing input focus
+
  // the avail ( but not used currenly ) flags are : hfl_show,hfl_custom,hfl_noautohidemove,hfl_noautohidemove 
// or
+
  procedure showhint(const sender: twidget; const hint: msestring;
// 2) has such widget, and this widget ( and all its descendants )  
+
              const apos: pointty;
//   pass "CanClose" check
+
              const ashowtime: integer = defaulthintshowtime; //0 -> inifinite,
//
+
                // -1 defaultshowtime if ow_timedhint in sender.optionswidget
// *** see also "twidget.CanClose" ***
+
              const aflags: hintflagsty = defaulthintflags
//
+
                      ); overload;
function candefocus: boolean;
+
 
 +
  // shows the hint fully defined in "info" for the widget "sender"
 +
  procedure showhint(const sender: twidget; const info: hintinfoty); overload;
 +
 
 +
  // removes the current hint widget & frees its resources & stops its stop timer
 +
  procedure hidehint;
 +
 
 +
  // restarts the current hint and its stop timer
 +
  procedure restarthint(const sender: twidget);
  
// tries to defocus the currently focused widget if it belongs to the window,
+
   function hintedwidget: twidget; //last hinted widget
// if succeeds then executes code of virtual "DoDefocus" of the widget descessor
+
   function activehintedwidget: twidget; //nil if no hint active
// ( this code defines behaviour & look of the widget on defocusing );
 
//
 
// no defocusing is done if the focused widget ( or its descendants )
 
// doesn't pass "CanClose" check
 
//
 
procedure nofocus;
 
 
 
  // setfocusedwidget(widget)
 
 
 
  property focuscount: cardinal read ffocuscount;
 
   function close: boolean; //true if ok
 
  procedure beginmoving; //lock window rect modification
 
  procedure endmoving;
 
  procedure bringtofront;
 
  procedure sendtoback;
 
  procedure stackunder(const predecessor: twindow);
 
      //stacking is performed in mainloop idle, nil means top
 
  procedure stackover(const predecessor: twindow);
 
      //stacking is performed in mainloop idle, nil means bottom
 
   function stackedunder: twindow; //nil if top
 
  function stackedover: twindow;  //nil if bottom
 
  function hastransientfor: boolean;
 
  
   procedure capturemouse;
+
   // returns helpcontext of active widget, '' if none;  
  procedure releasemouse;
+
   function activehelpcontext: msestring;
   procedure postkeyevent(const akey: keyty;
 
        const ashiftstate: shiftstatesty = []; const release: boolean = false;
 
                  const achars: msestring = '');
 
  
   function winid: winidty;
+
   // returns helpcontext of the widget under mouse, '' if none;
  function haswinid: boolean;
+
   function mousehelpcontext: msestring;
  function state: windowstatesty;
 
  function visible: boolean;
 
  function activating: boolean; //in internalactivate proc
 
  function normalwindowrect: rectty;
 
  property updateregion: regionty read fupdateregion;
 
   function updaterect: rectty;
 
  
   procedure registermovenotification(sender: iobjectlink);
+
   // TRUE if one of the app's window/console is in input focus
   procedure unregistermovenotification(sender: iobjectlink);
+
   function active: boolean;
  
   property options: windowoptionsty read foptions;
+
   // returns the desktop resolution ( or the virtual one if used )
 +
  function screensize: sizety;
  
// widget
+
  // returns the (virtual) desktop resolution except the tray area,
property owner: twidget read fowner;
+
  // nil -> current active window
 +
  function workarea(const awindow: twindow = nil): rectty;
  
   property focusedwidget: twidget read ffocusedwidget;
+
   // returns which application window ( a form not an eventwidget, an openglwidget or a windowwidget !)
   property transientfor: twindow read ftransientfor;
+
   // is active ( provides the input focus ),
   property modalresult: modalresultty read fmodalresult write setmodalresult;
+
   // it's same for all widgets of the form served by this window
   property buttonendmodal: boolean read getbuttonendmodal write setbuttonendmodal;
+
   function activewindow: twindow;
  property globalshortcuts: boolean read getglobalshortcuts write setglobalshortcuts;
 
  property localshortcuts: boolean read getlocalshortcuts write setlocalshortcuts;
 
  property windowpos: windowposty read getwindowpos write setwindowpos;
 
  property caption: msestring read fcaption write setcaption;
 
  
 +
/ * A transient window is a descendant of ( "transientfor" ) another window in the stacking order hierarchy */
  
windowoptionty = (wo_popup,wo_message,wo_buttonendmodal,wo_groupleader,
+
  // returns a first non-transient ( on top of the app stacking order ) window upward
                  wo_windowcentermessage); //showmessage centered in window
+
  // from the currently active window of the application.
 +
  // or that active window if no such
 +
  function regularactivewindow: twindow;
  
 +
  // same as "activewindow" but the window must not be released (?)
 +
  function unreleasedactivewindow: twindow;
  
optionswindow:
+
  // returns the focused widget of the currently active window if one exists
wo_popup
+
  function activewidget: twidget;
- in run-time, hides all OS windows-manager ( WM ) decorations (title bar, buttons "Close/Resize,Min/Max" etc),
 
letting only its client area to appear
 
so :
 
= the window should have own facilities to replace the deactivated WM functionality if needed
 
= can't be resized/maximize/minimized/moved
 
wo_message
 
- similar to "wo_popup" but allows WM to close ( with "Close" button ) & move the window
 
  
wo_groupleader
+
  // returns the widget presenteing the currently active window
- keeps on the WM taskbar a shortcut to the window  
+
  function activerootwidget: twidget;
( if the parent window is a groupleader too then dislpays a step upper in its group )
+
 
 +
  // returns the window ( not hidden or disabled !) under the screen point "pos"
 +
  function windowatpos(const pos: pointty): twindow;
  
Event handlers:
+
  // puts to "awidget" the container of widget pointed by "namepath"
 +
  // ( finalizing "." is discarded if found ) ,
 +
  // FALSE if not found, and NIL and TRUE if "namepath" = ''
 +
  function findwidget(const namepath: string; out awidget: twidget): boolean;
  
- onmove
+
  // rebuilds the application's window list accorrding to the current on-screen Z-order of its windows;
= fires once the (window/widget) is created/moved ( with check if really moved by a distance)
+
  // window list is ordered by "z" - bottom first & top last;
 +
  // invisibles first
 +
  procedure sortzorder;
  
<pre/>
+
  // returns a copy of the internal window list of application
=== TFaceList ===
+
  function windowar: windowarty;
=== TFrameComp ===
 
 
Terminilogy :
 
  
{client area = area of the widget which interacts with a user}
+
  // returns the list of application window winIDs
 +
  function winidar: winidarty;
  
{bevelling = additional facets rising/sinking frame & client area,
+
  // returns the count of the application windows   
constists of two parts -
+
  function windowcount: integer;
- external: between frame and widget
 
- internal: between frame and client area
 
}
 
  
{frame= flat space between external & internal facets,
+
  // returns the window by its number ( "index" >= 0) in the application window list
floats at the inner level of the external facet
+
  property windows[const index: integer]: twindow read getwindows;
}
 
  
*** Both frame & bevelling affect the client area ***
+
  // returns the lowest visible window in stackorder,
 +
  // calls "sortzorder" within
 +
  function bottomwindow: twindow;
  
--------------------------
+
  // returns the highest visible window in stackorder,
template:
+
  // calls "sortzorder" within
 +
  function topwindow: twindow;
  
colorclient = color of the client area
 
  
colorframe = color of the frame
+
  // TRUE if all owned windows pass "CanClose" check or
colorframeactive = used instead of colorframe if the widget is
+
  // don't have focused widgets
active; "cl_default" means same as colorframe.
+
  function candefocus: boolean;
  
works if (leveli/levelo <> 0 that's the facets exist :
+
  // subscribes the handler "method" to receive keyboard events
 +
  procedure registeronkeypress(const method: keyeventty);
  
colorshadow = color of facets screened from the NW light source
+
  // unsubscribes the handler "method" from receiving keyboard events
colordkshadow = color of shadows dropped by the NW light source
+
  procedure unregisteronkeypress(const method: keyeventty);
                colordkwidth = width of the shadows in pixel, -1=default
 
  
colorlight = color of facets exposed to the NW light source
+
  // subscribes the handler "method" to receive shortcut events
colorhighlight = color of brighter edges of the facets
+
  procedure registeronshortcut(const method: keyeventty);
                colorhlwidth = width of the brighter edges in pixel, -1=default
 
  
        extraspace = if applied to menu items, adds more space between these items
+
  // unsubscribes the handler "method" from receiving shortcut events
 +
  procedure unregisteronshortcut(const method: keyeventty);
  
framei_:
+
  // subscribes the handler "method" to receive "OnWindowActiveChanged" event ( form-wide )
(for extendable widgets like menus, these settings widen the widget,
+
  procedure registeronactivechanged(const method: activechangeeventty);
for non-extendable like buttons - they squeeze the text area )
 
  
bottom= lower margin of text to the client area
+
  // unsubscribes the handler "method" from receiving "OnWindowActiveChanged" event ( form-wide )
left = left margin of text to the client area
+
  procedure unregisteronactivechanged(const method: activechangeeventty);
right = margin of text to the client area
 
top = upper margin of text to the client area
 
  
framewidth= width of the frame
+
  // subscribes the handler "method" to receive "OnDestroyed" events ( form-wide )
leveli = {width=height} of the internal facet, positive -> raised, negative -> sunken
+
  procedure registeronwindowdestroyed(const method: windoweventty);
levelo = {width=height} of the external facet, positive -> raised, negative -> sunken
 
  
<any frame>
+
  // unsubscribes the handler "method" from receiving "OnDestroyed" events ( form-wide )
 +
  procedure unregisteronwindowdestroyed(const method: windoweventty);
  
*** extends & customizes "tframecomp" ***
+
  // subscribes the handler "method" to receive "OnWindowDestroyed" events ( form-wide )
 +
  procedure registeronwiniddestroyed(const method: winideventty);
  
template
+
  // unsubscribes the handler "method" form receiving "OnWindowDestroyed" events ( form-wide )
- "tframecomp" supplying the initial settings
+
  procedure unregisteronwiniddestroyed(const method: winideventty);
  
colorclient,colordkshadow,colordkwidth,colorframe,colorframeactive,
+
  // subscribes the handler "method" to receive "ApplicationActiveChanged" events ( form-wide )
colorhighlight,colorhlwidth,colorlight,colorshadow,framewidth,
+
  procedure registeronapplicationactivechanged(const method: booleaneventty);
leveli, levelo, framei_*,
 
  
<see "tframecomp">
+
  // unsubscribes the handler "method" from receiving "ApplicationActiveChanged" events ( form-wide )
 +
  procedure unregisteronapplicationactivechanged(const method: booleaneventty);
  
font
+
// tcustomapplication
<see "tfont">
 
  
caption
+
  // subscribes the handler "method" to receive "OnTerminated" event ( form-wide )
- some descriptive text( function name, user prompt,...) placed
+
  procedure registeronterminated(const method: notifyeventty);
in a N/W/S/E-combination to the widget's client area
 
  
***
+
  // unsubscribes the handler "method" from receiving "OnTerminated" events ( form-wide )
non-empty caption if (captionpos <> cp_center) & (captiondistouter=false & captiondist>0) enlarges the framed widget
+
  procedure unregisteronterminated(const method: notifyeventty);
by the corresponding size of caption
 
  
***
+
  // subscribes the handler "method" to receive "OnTerminateQuery" event ( form-wide )
 +
  procedure registeronterminate(const method: terminatequeryeventty);
  
captiondist - margin between the caption & the client area
+
  // unsubscribes the handler "method" from receiving "OnTerminateQuery" event ( form-wide )
 +
  procedure unregisteronterminate(const method: terminatequeryeventty);
  
captiondistouter :
+
  // subscribes the handler "method" to receive "OnIdle" event ( form-wide )
 +
  procedure registeronidle(const method: idleeventty);
  
- if "false"(by default), the distance is measured between
+
  // unsubscribes the handler "method" from receiving "OnIdle" events ( form-wide )
the inner (facing the client area) extent of the caption
+
  procedure unregisteronidle(const method: idleeventty);
and the client area outward the area,
 
the caption is placed outside of the client area
 
  
- if "true", the caption is mirrored against the edge of client area as
+
  // calls "canclose" of all application windows except the "sender" window
to the position when "false"
+
  // if all "canclose"are TRUE then checks "OnTerminateQuery"  
 +
  // for all its subscribers ( usually forms of the application )
 +
  procedure terminate(const sender: twindow = nil);
  
*** nagative values of "captiondist" visually inverse "out of" and within ***
+
  // TRUE as long as a "terminate" call is in progress
 +
  function terminating: boolean;
  
      captionnoclip - do not clip frame and client area for caption background
+
  // TRUE as long as a "deinitialize" call is in progress
( the client area preserves own background under the caption text)
+
  function deinitializing: boolean;
 +
 
 +
  // returns the current caret object ( the text input focus indicator ) of the application
 +
  / ( this object provides facilities to control position & appearance & visibility & timings of the caret )
 +
  property caret: tcaret read fcaret;
  
captionnooffset - shift orthogonal to "captiondist"
+
  // returns the current mouse object of the application
 +
  / ( this object provides facitities to control position & appearance of the mouse ) 
 +
  property mouse: tmouse read fmouse;
  
captionpos - "corner" where to place the caption
+
  // simulates mouseparkevent
 +
  // ( an adjusting mouse movement without user intervention - grid snapping, docking etc ?)
 +
  procedure mouseparkevent;
  
localprops :
+
  // sets mouse position correction for further mouse events,
 +
  // the real position is less the visual one by the supplied shift
 +
  procedure delayedmouseshift(const ashift: pointty);
  
frl_levelo - "levelo" overrides "template.levelo"
+
  // returns/sets a cursor shape used for widgets having their cursor shape set to "cr_default";
frl_leveli - "leveli" overrides "template.leveli"
+
  // setting it to "cr_default" restores the individual widget cursor(s)
frl_framewidth - "framewidth" overrides "template.framewidth"
+
  property widgetcursorshape: cursorshapety read fwidgetcursorshape write
frl_colorclient - "colorclient" overrides "template.colorclient"
+
                                        fwidgetcursorshape;
frl_colorframe - "colorframe" overrides "template.colorframe"
+
 
frl_colorframeactive - "colorframeactive" overrides "template.colorframeactive"
+
  // returns/sets the current application-wide cursor shape ( not "watches" if a waiting dialog is currently displayed ! )
frl_colordkshadow - "colordkshadow" overrides "template.colordkshadow"
+
  // or request to set a new cursor shape ( app-wide );
frl_colorshadow - "colorshadow" overrides "template.colorshadow"
+
  // doesn't change when changing mouse widgets
frl_colorlight - "colorlight" overrides "template.colorlight"
+
  //
frl_colorhighlight - "colorhighlight" overrides "template.colorhighlight"
+
  // if called from a non-main app thread & no waiting dialogue displayed then redraws
frl_colordkwidth - "colordkwidth" overrides "template.colordkwidth"
+
  // the cursor immediately;
frl_colorhlwidth - "colorhlwidth" overrides "template.colorhlwidth"
+
  // set it to "cr_default" to restore the shape to one set by "widgetcursorshape"
frl_fileft - "framei_left" overrides "template.framei_left"
+
  //
frl_firight - "framei_right" overrides "template.framei_right"
+
  property cursorshape: cursorshapety; // cr_arrow, cr_*
frl_fitop - "framei_top" overrides "template.framei_top"
 
frl_fibottom - "framei_bottom" overrides "template.framei_bottom"
 
  
frl_nodisable
+
  // assures the displayed mouse cursor shape to be the shape assigned to the currently under-mouse widget,
 +
  // otherwise "cr_default"
 +
  procedure updatecursorshape; //restores cursorshape of mousewidget
  
=== TFaceComp ===
+
  // returns a widget of the application where the mouse is currently positioned over
- doesn't affect the widget frame but client area of the frame
+
  property mousewidget: twidget read fmousewidget;
  
 +
  // returns a widget of the application currently "owning" the mouse ( grabbing all mouse input )
 +
  property mousecapturewidget: twidget read fmousecapturewidget;
  
template:
 
fade:
 
color[i]: = colors forming the fade
 
direction: = direction where the fade grows to
 
gd_(right/up/left/down)
 
  
pos[i]: = relational position of color[i] on the direction (0.0..1.0) extent
+
  // returns/sets a window to become the main window of the application
 +
  // then resets all other application windows to the window group it belongs to ( Linux only );
 +
  //
 +
  // the main window minimizes all windows if minimized;
 +
  property mainwindow: twindow read fmainwindow write setmainwindow;
  
transparency = makes the face half-transparent and enlight the underlying widget 
+
  // returns which system thread was allocated to the application on its start
with a light source of the selected color
+
  // ( the main thread )
( in this case, colors of the face & the widget & the light source
+
  property thread: threadty read fthread;
simply summarize to higher brightness )
 
  
image:
+
  // returns teh widget where a mouse button click occured last time
see <any image>
+
  // ( to compare with when determinibg whether another widget is clicked )
 +
  property buttonpresswidgetbefore: twidget read fbuttonpresswidgetbefore;
  
options:
+
  // returns teh widget where a mouse button release occured last time
 +
  // ( to compare with when determinibg whether another widget is clicked )
 +
  property buttonreleasewidgetbefore: twidget read fbuttonreleasewidgetbefore;
  
        *** The fade colors are used not as colors but RGB alpha values ($00 -> opaque, $ff -> transparent)
 
if fao_alpha* are set *** :
 
  
fao_alphafadeall = applies blending to the widget & all its childs
+
  // returns/sets the interval of mouse double click recognition ( in microsecs ),
fao_alphafadenochildren = preserves child widgets from blending
+
  // defaults to 0.4 sec
                fao_alphafadeimage = applies blending to "face.image"
+
  property dblclicktime: integer read fdblclicktime write fdblclicktime default
 +
                defaultdblclicktime; //us
  
 +
// tcustomapplication
  
<any face>
+
  // creates a datamodule instance ( its startup code including "OnLoaded" is executed )
 +
  procedure createdatamodule(instanceclass: msecomponentclassty; var reference);
  
*** extends & customizes "tfacecomp" ***
 
  
fade, image, option
+
  // enters the application event loop;
- see "tfacecomp"
+
  //
+
  // once the loop finishes, performs "OnTerminated" for all its subscribers,
template
+
  // destroys all application forms ( components & windows )
- "tfacecomp" supplying the initial settings
+
  procedure run;
  
localprops :
+
  // TRUE if the eventloop is entered
fal_options - "options" overrides "template.options"
+
  function running: boolean;
fal_fadirection - "fade.direction" overrides "template.fade.direction"
 
fal_image - "image" overrides "template.image"
 
fal_fapos - "fade.pos[i]" overrides "template.fade.pos[i]"
 
fal_facolor - "fade.color[i]" overrides "template.fade.color[i]"
 
fal_fatransparency - "fade.transparency" overrides "template.fade.transparency"
 
  
=== TBitmapComp ===
+
  // returns/sets the application name
=== TImageList ===
+
  // ( defaults to the full path to application executable in the native OS format );
=== TPopupMenu ===
+
  // currently, only for informatiion query purposes
=== TMainMenu ===
+
  property applicationname: msestring read fapplicationname write fapplicationname;
 +
 
  
== Dialog ==
+
  // if exclusive "rights" are satisfied for the main thread ( a mutex lock is OK )  & the event loop is in progress
=== TFileListview ===
+
  // then posts the "event" to the main application thread for asyc processing,
=== TFileDialog ===
+
  // otherwise adds the event to the internal list for further handling as soon as the above conditions meet
=== TFaceComp ===
+
  procedure postevent(event: tevent);
=== TFileNameEdit ===
 
=== TDirDropdownEdit ===
 
=== TColorEdit ===
 
=== TMemoDialogEdit ===
 
=== TPageSizeSelector ===
 
=== TPageOrientationSelector ===
 
  
== Application ==
+
  // TRUE if never idle since last call,
=== TGuiApplication ===
+
  // unlocks the application and calls sleep if not mainthread and asleepus >= 0
<pre>
+
  function checkoverload(const asleepus: integer = 100000): boolean;
tguiapplication = class(tcustomapplication)
 
  public
 
  
   // [re]starts the system timer with the new period and
+
   // returns/sets the application exception handler
  // subscribes the application to be a receiver of the modified "ek_timer" event
+
   property onexception: exceptioneventty read fonexception write fonexception;
  // ( can check for it in the event queue )
 
   procedure settimer(const us: integer);
 
  
   // finds a window by its winID
+
   // if not "eabort" & no unhandled exceptions,
   function findwindow(id: winidty; out window: twindow): boolean;
+
   // executes the above "OnException" code if assigned
 +
  // or shows an exception message otherwise;
 +
  procedure handleexception(sender: tobject = nil;  
 +
                                      const leadingtext: string = '');
  
   // finds a window by its ID & adjusts "rect" so that it
+
   // synchronizes the calling thread with the main event loop ( via a mutex),
   // fits "bounds_minc*" & "bounds_maxc*" of the found window
+
   // TRUE if the calling thread allready holds the mutex,
   procedure checkwindowrect(winid: winidty; var rect: rectty);
+
   // the mutex is recursive
 +
  function lock: boolean;
  
   // inits the timer and "megraphics"
+
   // tries to synchronize the calling thread with the main event loop ( via a mutex)
   procedure initialize;
+
   function trylock: boolean;
  
   // frees the allocated system resources (GDI, event subsription, the timer)
+
   // releases the mutex if the calling thread holds the mutex,
   procedure deinitialize;
+
   // TRUE if no unlock done
 +
  function unlock: boolean;
  
   // creates a form instance, it will be shown in "application.run"
+
   // releases the mutex recursively if the calling thread holds the mutex,
   procedure createform(instanceclass: widgetclassty; var reference);
+
  // returns "count" for the below "relockall"
 +
   function unlockall: integer;
  
   // invalidates all registered forms ( all their widgets will be redrawn )
+
   // regains the mutex to serve "count" locks
   procedure invalidate;
+
   procedure relockall(count: integer);
 
 
  // calls a nested main eventloop, forces processing any pending messages,
 
  procedure processmessages; override; //handle with care!
 
  
   // TRUE if no pending events to process for the application
+
  // creates a syncronize event ( which will fire asyncronously then waits for another thread will allow it to finish ), assigns "proc" to it as the event handler,
   function idle: boolean; override;
+
  // then frees all locks temporarily then posts the event to the app event queue & waits fot it to be processed the resores the locks;
    
+
  //
   // requests to indicate waiting ( to show the "watches" cursos )
+
   // TRUE if not aborted, quiet -> shows no exceptions if occurs
   procedure beginwait; override;
+
   //
 +
   // the "syncronize event" is an event owning a semaphore which can be touched by another thread
 +
   // thus causing "event.waitfo" to return & to exec the event handler code
 +
  //
 +
   function synchronize(const proc: objectprocty;
 +
                      const quite: boolean = false): boolean;
  
   // removes the "watches" if no unclosed requests for displaying them,
+
   // TRUE if the calling ( this function ) thread is the application main thread
  // otherwise closes the currently active request
+
   function ismainthread: boolean;
   procedure endwait; override;
 
  
   // TRUE if there're unclosed requests for displaying "watches"
+
   // TRUE if the currently locked thread is the application main thread
   function waiting: boolean;
+
   function islockthread: boolean;
  
   // TRUE if ESC has just been pressed
+
   // waith for "athread" to terminate,
  //  - if all requests for displaying "watches" are closed then refreshes
+
   // does "unlock-relock" around waiting
   //   the internal list of events ( the GUI-queue -> the app event list)
+
   procedure waitforthread(athread: tmsethread);
   function waitescaped: boolean; //true if escape pressed while waiting
 
  
   // sets state of the current wait dialogue ( but doesn't close one ) to undefined
+
   // post a "nothing-to-do" event for asynchronous processing in the main thread
   procedure resetwaitdialog;  
+
   procedure wakeupmainthread;
  
   // runs "aexecuteaction" in the main thread in OnIdle mode,
+
   // invalidates all registered forms of the application so that their widgets redraw land-specific captions
   // then shows a cancellable message,
+
   // ( changed by "mseconsts.setlangconsts" ),
  // if the one is cancelled then runs "acancelaction" then
+
   // called internally in "setlangconsts" before return
  // either fully clears (if exceptions occur )  
+
   procedure langchanged; virtual;
  // or terminates the execution otherwise,
 
   // true if not cancelled;
 
  // "application.processmessages" must be called regularly if "aexecuteaction" is used here,
 
   // alternatively "aidleaction" can be used, call sleep ( some time ) in order to minimize
 
  // processor load.
 
  // If athread <> nil the function starts and terminates the thread   
 
  function waitdialog(const athread: tthreadcomp = nil; const atext: msestring = '';
 
                  const caption: msestring = '';
 
                  const acancelaction: notifyeventty = nil;
 
                  const aexecuteaction: notifyeventty = nil): boolean; override;
 
  
   // closes the currently modal waitdialogue with "cancelled" state
+
   // returns/sets "aps_terminated" state flag ( no actions ? )
   procedure cancelwait;
+
  // this flag is also set internally by "terminate" if not cancelled
 +
   property terminated: boolean read getterminated write setterminated;
  
   // closes the currently modal waitdialogue with "ok" state
+
   // returns the number of "handleexception" calls having an effect ( a message or the handler code )
   procedure terminatewait;
+
   property exceptioncount: longword read fexceptioncount;
  
  function waitstarted: boolean;  // the last waitdialogue is currently showing for some requests
 
  function waitcanceled: boolean;  // the last waitdialogue has been cancelled for some request (but can be shown fot others ?)
 
  function waitterminated: boolean; // the last waitdialogue has been terminated for some request (but can be shown fot others ?)
 
  
  // if called from the main app thread then shows as a modal message describing the exception
+
private
  // otherwise posts an async event for which the message will be called
+
// function tinternalapplication.beginmodal(const sender: twindow): boolean;
  procedure showexception(e: exception; const leadingtext: string = ''); override;
 
  
  // posts an async event for which the message describing the exception will be called
+
</pre>
  procedure showasyncexception(e: exception; const leadingtext: string = '');
 
  
  // "application.errormessage" shows standard error message ( with "ERROR" title )
+
== DB ==
  procedure errormessage(const amessage: msestring); override;
 
  
  // [re]calculates timings & position of hint for "ahintedwidget"
+
=== DBedit ===
  // if "ow_timedhint" in "ahintedwidget.foptionswidget" then iys showtime will be
+
=== DBfields ===
  // "defaulthintshowtime" ( an app wide setting, 3sec by default)    
+
=== TDBwidgetgrid ===
  procedure inithintinfo(var info: hintinfoty; const ahintedwidget: twidget);
+
<pre>
 +
   Properties:
  
 +
        anchors - ...
 +
bounds - ...
  
  // shows the supplied hint text within "aposrect" with alignment "aplacement" during "ashowtime",
+
color
  // the avail ( but not used currenly ) flags are : hfl_show,hfl_custom,hfl_noautohidemove,hfl_noautohidemove 
+
- color of the grid's client area
  procedure showhint(const sender: twidget; const hint: msestring;
+
cursor
              const aposrect: rectty; const aplacement: captionposty = cp_bottomleft;
+
- cursor shape when the mouse is over the client area
              const ashowtime: integer = defaulthintshowtime; //0 -> inifinite,
 
                // -1 defaultshowtime if ow_timedhint in sender.optionswidget
 
              const aflags: hintflagsty = defaulthintflags
 
                      ); overload;
 
  
  // shows the supplied hint text at left-top position"apos" during "ashowtime",
+
datacols
  // the avail ( but not used currenly ) flags are : hfl_show,hfl_custom,hfl_noautohidemove,hfl_noautohidemove 
+
colorselect
  procedure showhint(const sender: twidget; const hint: msestring;
+
linecolor
              const apos: pointty;
+
linecolorfix
              const ashowtime: integer = defaulthintshowtime; //0 -> inifinite,
+
linewidth
                // -1 defaultshowtime if ow_timedhint in sender.optionswidget
+
newrowcol
              const aflags: hintflagsty = defaulthintflags
 
                      ); overload;
 
  
  // shows the hint fully defined in "info" for the widget "sender"
+
options
  procedure showhint(const sender: twidget; const info: hintinfoty); overload;
+
co_readonly
 
+
co_nofocus
  // removes the current hint widget & frees its resources & stops its stop timer
+
co_invisible
  procedure hidehint;
+
co_disabled
 +
co_drawfocus
 +
co_mousemovefocus
 +
co_lefbuttonfocusonly
 +
co_focusselect
 +
co_mouseselect
 +
co_keyselect
 +
co_multiselect
 +
co_resetselectionexit
 +
co_rowselect
 +
co_fixwidth
 +
co_fixpos
 +
co_fill
 +
co_proportional
 +
co_nohscroll
 +
co_savevalue
 +
co_savestate
 +
co_rowfont
 +
co_rowcolor
 +
co_zebracolor
 +
co_nosort
 +
co_sortdescent
 +
co_norearrange
 +
co_cancopy
 +
co_canpaste
 +
co_mousescrollrow
 +
co_rowdatachange
  
  // restarts the current hint and its stop timer
+
sortcol
  procedure restarthint(const sender: twidget);
+
width
  
  function hintedwidget: twidget; //last hinted widget
+
items[N]
  function activehintedwidget: twidget; //nil if no hint active
+
color
 
+
colorselect
  // returns helpcontext of active widget, '' if none; 
+
datalist - ???
  function activehelpcontext: msestring;
+
face - see <any face>
 +
fontselect - see <any font>
 +
frame - see <any frame>
 +
linecolor
 +
linecolorfix
 +
linewidth
 +
name
 +
 +
options
 +
 +
</pre>
  
  // returns helpcontext of the widget under mouse, '' if none;
+
=== Report ===
  function mousehelpcontext: msestring;
 
  
  // TRUE if one of the app's window/console is in input focus
+
==== TRepSpacer ====
  function active: boolean;
+
==== TRecordBand ====
 +
==== TrepValueDisp ====
 +
==== TRepPageNumdisp ====
 +
==== TRepPrintDateDisp ====
 +
==== TBandGroup ====
 +
==== TTileArea ====
  
  // returns the desktop resolution ( or the virtual one if used )
+
== Design ==
  function screensize: sizety;
 
  
  // returns the (virtual) desktop resolution except the tray area,
+
=== TGdbMi ===
  // nil -> current active window
+
=== TSyntaxEdit ===
  function workarea(const awindow: twindow = nil): rectty;
+
=== TSyntaxPainter ===
  
  // returns which application window ( a form not an eventwidget, an openglwidget or a windowwidget !)
+
== Comm ==
  // is active ( provides the input focus ),
+
 
  // it's same for all widgets of the form served by this window
+
=== TCommPort ===
  function activewindow: twindow;
+
=== TAsciiCommPort ===
 +
=== TAsciiProtPort ===
 +
=== TCommSelector ===
  
/ * A transient window is a descendant of ( "transientfor" ) another window in the stacking order hierarchy */
+
== General stuff==
  
  // returns a first non-transient ( on top of the app stacking order ) window upward
+
=== Properties for all widgets ===
  // from the currently active window of the application.
+
<pre>
  // or that active window if no such
 
  function regularactivewindow: twindow;
 
  
  // same as "activewindow" but the window must not be released (?)
+
name
  function unreleasedactivewindow: twindow;
 
  
  // returns the focused widget of the currently active window if one exists
+
anchors
  function activewidget: twidget;
 
  
  // returns the widget presenteing the currently active window
+
-----------
  function activerootwidget: twidget;
 
 
 
  // returns the window ( not hidden or disabled !) under the screen point "pos"
 
  function windowatpos(const pos: pointty): twindow;
 
  
  // puts to "awidget" the container of widget pointed by "namepath"
+
- they control of design/runtime sticking widgets to their parents
  // ( finalizing "." is discarded if found ) ,
 
  // FALSE if not found, and NIL and TRUE if "namepath" = ''
 
  function findwidget(const namepath: string; out awidget: twidget): boolean;
 
  
  // rebuilds the application's window list accorrding to the current on-screen Z-order of its windows;
+
- dimention pair ( top/bottom or left/right ) both set to "false" cause
  // window list is ordered by "z" - bottom first & top last;
+
the widget to fit the parent's client area in that dimention;
  // invisibles first
+
this effect may be partial in case of "bounds_c*max" settings limit the extents
  procedure sortzorder;
 
  
  // returns a copy of the internal window list of application
+
*** Return to the look "before dimention fit" is only possible by manual resizing or setting "bounds_*"
  function windowar: windowarty;
+
-----------
 +
an_left
 +
- on run-time, resizes/shifts left the widget to keep the design-set distance
 +
between the widget's left border and the left side of parent's client area
 +
as the parent resizes, until scrolling begins
  
  // returns the list of application window winIDs
+
an_top
  function winidar: winidarty;
+
- on run-time, resizes/shifts up the widget to keep the design-set distance
 +
between the widget's top border and the upper side of parent's client area
 +
as the parent resizes, until scrolling begins
  
  // returns the count of the application windows   
+
an_right
  function windowcount: integer;
+
- on run-time, resizes/shifts right the widget to keep the design-set distance
 +
between the widget's right border and the right side of parent's client area
 +
as the parent resizes, until scrolling begins
  
  // returns the window by its number ( "index" >= 0) in the application window list
+
an_bottom
  property windows[const index: integer]: twindow read getwindows;
+
- on run-time, resizes/shifts down the widget to keep the design-set distance
 +
between the widget's bottom border and the lower side of parent's client area
 +
as the parent resizes, until scrolling begins
  
  // returns the lowest visible window in stackorder,
+
bounds
  // calls "sortzorder" within
 
  function bottomwindow: twindow;
 
  
  // returns the highest visible window in stackorder,  
+
cx - width of the widget
  // calls "sortzorder" within
+
cxmax, cxmin - design/runtime width of the widget is enforced between "cxmax" and "cxmin"
  function topwindow: twindow;
+
cy - height of the widget
 +
cymax, cymin - design/runtime height of the widget is enforced between "cymax" and "cymin"
 +
x - distance between the widget's left border and the left side of parent's client area
 +
y - distance between the widget's top border and the upper side of parent's client area
  
  
  // TRUE if all owned windows pass "CanClose" check or
+
autosize
  // don't have focused widgets
 
  function candefocus: boolean;
 
  
  // subscribes the handler "method" to receive keyboard events
+
-----------
  procedure registeronkeypress(const method: keyeventty);
+
- only applicable to widgets with "ow_autosize" set
 +
- the effect may be partial in case when "bounds_c*max" settings limit the extents
 +
-----------
  
  // unsubscribes the handler "method" from receiving keyboard events
+
cx - addition to width of the widget (with h-centering post applied)
  procedure unregisteronkeypress(const method: keyeventty);
+
cy - addition to height of the widget (with v-centering post applied)
  
  // subscribes the handler "method" to receive shortcut events
+
- color
  procedure registeronshortcut(const method: keyeventty);
+
= the default color of client area & caption text background
 +
= may be overwritten:
 +
* the client area - with "frame.colorclient"
 +
* the caption BG - with "frame.font.colorbackground"
  
  // unsubscribes the handler "method" from receiving shortcut events
+
- font
  procedure unregisteronshortcut(const method: keyeventty);
+
= see {any font}
  
  // subscribes the handler "method" to receive "OnWindowActiveChanged" event ( form-wide )
+
- frame
  procedure registeronactivechanged(const method: activechangeeventty);
+
= see {any frame}
  
  // unsubscribes the handler "method" from receiving "OnWindowActiveChanged" event ( form-wide )
+
- face
  procedure unregisteronactivechanged(const method: activechangeeventty);
+
= see {any face}
  
  // subscribes the handler "method" to receive "OnDestroyed" events ( form-wide )
+
- hint
  procedure registeronwindowdestroyed(const method: windoweventty);
+
= descriptive text appearing when mouse pointer enters the widget
  
  // unsubscribes the handler "method" from receiving "OnDestroyed" events ( form-wide )
+
- cursor
  procedure unregisteronwindowdestroyed(const method: windoweventty);
+
= shape of the mouse pointer over the client area of widget (run-time only)
  
  // subscribes the handler "method" to receive "OnWindowDestroyed" events ( form-wide )
+
- visible
  procedure registeronwiniddestroyed(const method: winideventty);
+
= "true" allow the widget to appear ( run-time only )
  
  // unsubscribes the handler "method" form receiving "OnWindowDestroyed" events ( form-wide )
+
- enabled
  procedure unregisteronwiniddestroyed(const method: winideventty);
+
= "true" allows the widget to participate in GUI interaction
 +
= "false" disallows the widget & its children :
 +
* processing all events & shortcuts & menu calls
 +
* auto "CanClose" check
  
  // subscribes the handler "method" to receive "ApplicationActiveChanged" events ( form-wide )
+
Also "false" usually paints the widget in color marking
  procedure registeronapplicationactivechanged(const method: booleaneventty);
+
the "disabled" state ( usually light gray font color )
  
  // unsubscribes the handler "method" from receiving "ApplicationActiveChanged" events ( form-wide )
+
- popupmenu
  procedure unregisteronapplicationactivechanged(const method: booleaneventty);
+
= reference to a preset tpopupmenu widget serving the right-click menu
  
// tcustomapplication
+
- taborder
 +
- {0..N} order number when TAB-key cycling through widgets in the container
  
  // subscribes the handler "method" to receive "OnTerminated" event ( form-wide )
+
- tag
  procedure registeronterminated(const method: notifyeventty);
+
- an integer value bound to this widget instance
  
  // unsubscribes the handler "method" from receiving "OnTerminated" events ( form-wide )
+
- helpcontext
  procedure unregisteronterminated(const method: notifyeventty);
+
= a string returned by "(active/mouse)helpcontext" methods of the owning form  
 +
  when this widget is focused or under mouse in the active window
  
  // subscribes the handler "method" to receive "OnTerminateQuery" event ( form-wide )
+
- zorder
  procedure registeronterminate(const method: terminatequeryeventty);
+
= reading: finds the current Z-order of the widget's window
 +
= setting: if the value = 0 then lowers the widget's window in the stacking hierarchy, otherwise rises
  
  // unsubscribes the handler "method" from receiving "OnTerminateQuery" event ( form-wide )
 
  procedure unregisteronterminate(const method: terminatequeryeventty);
 
  
  // subscribes the handler "method" to receive "OnIdle" event ( form-wide )
+
optionswidget:
  procedure registeronidle(const method: idleeventty);
 
  
  // unsubscribes the handler "method" from receiving "OnIdle" events ( form-wide )
+
ow_background
  procedure unregisteronidle(const method: idleeventty);
+
- keeps the window/widget on bottom of the Z-order stack.
  
  // calls "canclose" of all application windows except the "sender" window  
+
ow_top
  // if all "canclose"are TRUE then checks "OnTerminateQuery"
+
- keeps the window/widget in foreground
  // for all its subscribers ( usually forms of the application )
 
  procedure terminate(const sender: twindow = nil);
 
  
  // TRUE as long as a "terminate" call is in progress
+
ow_noautosizing
  function terminating: boolean;
+
- when docking, not to resize for the docking area
  
  // TRUE as long as a "deinitialize" call is in progress
+
ow_mousefocus
  function deinitializing: boolean;
+
- "false" here disables focusing the widget with mouse
 
+
  ( and "OnFocus" doesn't fire on mouse clicks )
  // returns the current caret object ( the text input focus indicator ) of the application
+
 
  / ( this object provides facitities to control position & appearance & visibility & timings of the caret )
+
ow_tabfocus
  property caret: tcaret read fcaret;
+
- "false" here disables focusing the widget with "TAB" key
 +
  ( and "OnFocus" doesn't fire on TAB pressed )
  
  // returns the current mouse object of the application
+
ow_parenttabfocus
  / ( this object provides facitities to control position & appearance of the mouse ) 
+
- enters the childs on TAB-focusing then returns to the widget after
  property mouse: tmouse read fmouse;
+
sequential TAB-ing through its child widgets,
 +
otherwise TAB-ing cycles on the children if entered
  
  // simulates mouseparkevent
+
ow_arrowfocus
  // ( an adjusting mouse movement without user intervention - grid snapping, docking etc ?)
+
- allows the widget ( and its children in turn ) to be focused with
  procedure mouseparkevent;
+
the arrow keys
  
  // sets mouse position correction for further mouse events,
+
ow_subfocus, ow_arrowfocusin, ow_arrowfocusout
  // the real position is less the visual one by the supplied shift
+
- in case of arrow keys focusing enabled for child-containing widget,  
  procedure delayedmouseshift(const ashift: pointty);
+
determine behaviour on entering & leaving the widget, see the below table:
  
  // returns/sets a cursor shape used for widgets having their cursor shape set to "cr_default";
+
ow_subfocus | ow_arrowfocusin | ow_arrowfocusout | effect
  // setting it to "cr_default" restores the individual widget cursor(s)
 
  property widgetcursorshape: cursorshapety read fwidgetcursorshape write
 
                                        fwidgetcursorshape;
 
  
  // returns/sets the current application-wide cursor shape ( not "watches" if a waiting dialogue is curerntly displayed ! )
+
  FALSE          FALSE            FALSE        entering-/leaving-
  // or request to set a new cursor shape ( app-wide );
+
  FALSE          FALSE            TRUE          entering-/leaving+
  // doesn't change when changing mouse widgets
+
  FALSE          TRUE              FALSE        entering(nearest)+/leaving-
  //  
+
  FALSE          TRUE              TRUE          entering(nearest)+/leaving+
  // if called from a non-main app thread & no waiting dialogue displayed then redraws
+
  TRUE            FALSE            FALSE        entering(last focused)+/leaving-
  // the cursor immediately;
+
  TRUE            FALSE            TRUE          entering(last focused)+/leaving+
  // set it to "cr_default" to restore the shape to one set by "widgetcursorshape"
+
  TRUE            TRUE              FALSE        entering(nearest)+/leaving-
  //
+
  TRUE            TRUE              TRUE          entering(nearest)+/leaving+
  property cursorshape: cursorshapety; // cr_arrow, cr_*
 
  
  // assures the displayed mouse cursor shape to be the shape assigned to the currently under-mouse widget,
+
- "entering" is focusing on a child within the widget
  // otherwise "cr_default"
+
- "leaving"  is return from last child onto the widget's level
  procedure updatecursorshape; //restores cursorshape of mousewidget
+
- "nearest" is the child closest on the arrow direction
 +
- "last focused" is the child focused on last leaving the widget
 +
 +
*** The Up/Down arrow keys can leave from the children circle,
 +
but Left/Right can only toggle between the children ***
  
  // returns a widget of the application where the mouse is currently positioned over
+
*** mouse entering/leaving isn't controllable by these options
  property mousewidget: twidget read fmousewidget;
 
  
  // returns a widget of the application currently "owning" the mouse ( grabbing all mouse input )
 
  property mousecapturewidget: twidget read fmousecapturewidget;
 
  
 +
ow_focusbackonesc
 +
- on pressing "Esc", returns input focus to the previously focused widget
  
  // returns/sets a window to become the main window of the application
+
ow_noparentshortcut
  // then resets all other application windows to the window group it belongs to ( Linux only );
 
  //
 
  // the main window minimizes all windows if minimized;
 
  property mainwindow: twindow read fmainwindow write setmainwindow;
 
  
  // returns which system thread was allocated to the application on its start
+
*** disables processing of delegated ( from the parent ) shortcuts ***
  // ( the main thread )
 
  property thread: threadty read fthread;
 
  
  // returns teh widget where a mouse button click occured last time
+
- "true" here disables processing shortcuts if they're delegated
  // ( to compare with when determinibg whether another widget is clicked )
+
from the parent widget ( obviously, not processed by the parent )
  property buttonpresswidgetbefore: twidget read fbuttonpresswidgetbefore;
 
  
  // returns teh widget where a mouse button release occured last time
+
ow_nochildshortcut
  // ( to compare with when determinibg whether another widget is clicked )
 
  property buttonreleasewidgetbefore: twidget read fbuttonreleasewidgetbefore;
 
  
 +
*** disables delegating shortcuts to the parent for taking decision ***
  
  // returns/sets the interval of mouse double click recognition ( in microsecs),
+
- if "true" then the widget tries to process it by oneself
  // defaults to 0.4 sec
+
otherwise it's passed to the parent widget for further chaining
  property dblclicktime: integer read fdblclicktime write fdblclicktime default
 
                defaultdblclicktime; //us
 
  
// tcustomapplication
+
*** A shortcut can only be processed once ( by one widget ) ***
  
  // creates a datamodule instance ( its startup code including "OnLoaded" is executed )
+
ow_canclosenil
  procedure createdatamodule(instanceclass: msecomponentclassty; var reference);
+
- "true" here allows to continue even if there's contained widget(s)  
 +
not passing "CanClose" check
  
 +
ow_mousetransparent
 +
- "true" here causes the widget oneself ( not its contained ones )
 +
not to react to mouse events ( just allow them through to the children )
  
  // enters the application event loop;
+
ow_mousewheel
  //
+
- enables/disables {scrolling/navigating} with wheel of ImPS/2 etc mouse
  // once the loop finishes, performs "OnTerminated" for all its subscribers,
 
  // destroys all application forms ( components & windows )
 
  procedure run;
 
  
  // TRUE if the eventloop is entered
+
ow_noscroll
  function running: boolean;
+
- don't use screen image scrolling for twidget.scrollrect,
 +
redraw the whole scrolled widget rectangle instead;
 +
sometimes needed with background fades.
  
  // returns/sets the application name
+
ow_nochildpaintclip
  // ( defaults to the full path to application executable in the native OS format );
+
-
  // currently, only for informatiion query purposes
+
 
  property applicationname: msestring read fapplicationname write fapplicationname;
+
ow_destroywidgets
 
+
- "true" here causes calling "free" for all containing widgets as well
  
  // if exclusive "rights" are satisfied for the main thread ( a mutex lock is OK )  & the event loop is in progress
+
ow_hinton
  // then posts the "event" to the main application thread for asyc processing,
+
- to show the hint even in case of hinting is disabled on the parent
  // otherwise adds the event to the internal list for further handling as soon as the above conditions meet
+
( "parent.ow_hintoff= true & parent.ow_hinton= false" )
  procedure postevent(event: tevent);
 
  
  // TRUE if never idle since last call,
+
ow_hintoff
  // unlocks the application and calls sleep if not mainthread and asleepus >= 0
+
- "true" here combined with "ow_hinton=false" fully disables displaying the hint
  function checkoverload(const asleepus: integer = 100000): boolean;
 
  
  // returns/sets the application exception handler
+
ow_multiplehint
  property onexception: exceptioneventty read fonexception write fonexception;
+
- "true" here causes the widget to redisplay its hint on each {>3px} move within the widget oneself
  
  // if not "eabort" & no unhandled exceptions,
+
        ow_timedhint
  // executes the above "OnException" code if assigned
+
- "true" here causes hint of the widget to disappear after a timed inteval (about 2 secs by default)
  // or shows an exception message otherwise;
 
  procedure handleexception(sender: tobject = nil;
 
                                      const leadingtext: string = '');
 
  
  // synchronizes the calling thread with the main event loop ( via a mutex),
+
ow_fontlineheight (design-time only)
  // TRUE if the calling thread allready holds the mutex,
+
- causes "extraspace" of the last text line to be drawn,
  // the mutex is recursive
+
in turn it causes adjustment of widget height if "ow_autoscale" is set
  function lock: boolean;
+
 +
*** makes sence only if "ow_autoscale=true" & ow_autosize=false & "extraspace <> 0" ***
 +
 
 +
ow_fontglyphheight (design-time only)
 +
- causes only interline "extraspace"-s to be drawn, opposite to "ow_fontlineheight"
 +
 
 +
ow_autoscale (design-time only)
 +
- causes that if the contents change (design OR run-time) so that its' height changes
 +
then the widget will be v-scaled as well
  
  // tries to synchronize the calling thread with the main event loop ( via a mutex)
+
ow_autosize (design-time only)
  function trylock: boolean;
+
- causes that widget's height & width & client area adjust so that to provide space for contents of the client area
 +
- no design-time change of height/width are possible as long as this option is in effect
  
  // releases the mutex if the calling thread holds the mutex,
+
ow_autosizeanright
  // TRUE if no unlock done
+
- when autosizing & {an_right isn't set}, the design-set right margin against the parent is preserved
  function unlock: boolean;
 
  
  // releases the mutex recursively if the calling thread holds the mutex,
+
ow_autosizeanbottom
  // returns "count" for the below "relockall"
+
- when autosizing & {an_bottom isn't set}, the design-set bottom margin against the parent is preserved
  function unlockall: integer;
 
  
  // regains the mutex to serve "count" locks
+
optionsskin:
  procedure relockall(count: integer);
 
  
  // creates a syncronize event ( which will fire asyncronously then waits for another thread will allow it to finish ), assigns "proc" to it as the event handler,
+
- osc_noskin
  // then frees all locks temporarily then posts the event to the app event queue & waits fot it to be processed the resores the locks;
+
- osc_framebuttononly
  //
+
- osc_container
  // TRUE if not aborted, quiet -> shows no exceptions if occurs
 
  //
 
  // the "syncronize event" is an event owning a semaphore which can be touched by another thread
 
  // thus causing "event.waitfo" to return & to exec the event handler code
 
  //
 
  function synchronize(const proc: objectprocty;
 
                      const quite: boolean = false): boolean;
 
  
  // TRUE if the calling ( this function ) thread is the application main thread
 
  function ismainthread: boolean;
 
  
  // TRUE if the currently locked thread is the application main thread
+
Methods:
  function islockthread: boolean;
 
  
  // waith for "athread" to terminate,
+
  // tmsecomponent
  // does "unlock-relock" around waiting
 
  procedure waitforthread(athread: tmsethread);
 
  
  // post a "nothing-to-do" event for asynchronous processing in the main thread
+
// (re)draws the widget according to the related skin if apllicable;
  procedure wakeupmainthread;
+
//
 +
// also called internally by "loaded" procedure ( before "OnLoaded" code ),
 +
// by ShowMessage ( for the internal widgets of the message dialogue ),
 +
// when creating tab & form & menu widgets
 +
procedure updateskin(const recursive: boolean = false);
  
  // invalidates all registered forms of the application so that their widgets redraw land-specific captions
+
// TRUE if the instance is created but not yet ready
  // ( changed by "mseconsts.setlangconsts" ),
+
// for interaction & accessing data & appearance change & receiving events etc
  // called internally in "setlangconsts" before return
+
// ( the stage between firing "OnCreate" & "OnLoaded" )
  procedure langchanged; virtual;
+
function loading: boolean;
 
+
  // returns/sets "aps_terminated" state flag ( no actions ? )
+
{$ifdef FPC}
  // this flag is also set internally by "terminate" if not cancelled
+
procedure setinline(value: boolean); // ?
  property terminated: boolean read getterminated write setterminated;
+
procedure setancestor(value: boolean); // ?
 +
{$endif}
  
  // returns the number of "handleexception" calls having an effect ( a message or the handler code )
+
// TRUE if all conditios are OK for executing the code of "event" ( a handler must be assigned to the event )
  property exceptioncount: longword read fexceptioncount;
+
function canevent(const event: tmethod): boolean;
  
  
private
+
// Shortly, replaces the persistent storage of the widget
// function tinternalapplication.beginmodal(const sender: twindow): boolean;
+
//
 +
// if {value <> nil} then
 +
// - if "instance" is nil then calls "createproc" to create the instance,
 +
//    then assigns the instance's value:= "value"
 +
// otherwise frees "instance"
 +
procedure setoptionalobject(const value: tpersistent; var instance;
 +
                        createproc: createprocty);
  
<pre/>
+
// creates the persistent storage of the widget via calling "createproc"
 +
procedure getoptionalobject(const instance: tobject; createproc: createprocty);
  
== DB ==
+
// obtains & puts to "obj" a CORBA interface entry for "aintf" (GUID,...)
 +
function getcorbainterface(const aintf: ptypeinfo; out obj) : boolean;
  
=== DBedit ===
+
        // TRUE if the widget is owned, or "self" otherwise
=== DBfields ===
+
function checkowned(component: tcomponent): boolean;
=== TDBwidgetgrid ===
 
<pre>
 
  Properties:
 
  
         anchors - ...
+
         // TRUE if the widget is owner, or "self" otherwise
bounds - ...
+
function checkowner(component: tcomponent): boolean;
 +
 
 +
// return the top-most widget in owner chain starting from this widget
 +
function rootowner: tcomponent;
  
color
+
// return the array of owning widgets starting from this widget
- color of the grid's client area
+
// componentarty[0] is the widget oneself
cursor
+
function getrootcomponentpath: componentarty;
- cursor shape when the mouse is over the client area
 
  
datacols
+
        // returns items of objeclinker ( which notify this widget )
colorselect
+
        // and free notify list ( which are notified by this widget ),
linecolor
+
        // duplicates are removed.
linecolorfix
+
        //
linewidth
+
        // Notifies mainly relate to insertion/removal operation on widgets
newrowcol
+
        // The notify list is maintained by FreeNotification & RemoveFreeNotification
 +
function linkedobjects: objectarty;
  
options
+
// sends "event" recursively to child widgets until no more children or
co_readonly
+
// the event is processed ( cea_processed ) by one of the children,
co_nofocus
+
// "event" will be destroyed if destroyevent= true and not async
co_invisible
+
procedure sendcomponentevent(const event: tcomponentevent;
co_disabled
+
                                        const destroyevent: boolean = true);
co_drawfocus
+
 
co_mousemovefocus
+
// sends "event" to each of owning widgets downward from the root owner,
co_lefbuttonfocusonly
+
// "event" will be destroyed if destroyevent= true and not async
co_focusselect
+
procedure sendrootcomponentevent(const event: tcomponentevent;
co_mouseselect
+
                                        const destroyevent: boolean = true);
co_keyselect
+
 
co_multiselect
+
// posts an async "atag"-ged event to be handled by oneself
co_resetselectionexit
+
procedure asyncevent(atag: integer = 0);
co_rowselect
 
co_fixwidth
 
co_fixpos
 
co_fill
 
co_proportional
 
co_nohscroll
 
co_savevalue
 
co_savestate
 
co_rowfont
 
co_rowcolor
 
co_zebracolor
 
co_nosort
 
co_sortdescent
 
co_norearrange
 
co_cancopy
 
co_canpaste
 
co_mousescrollrow
 
co_rowdatachange
 
  
sortcol
+
// posts a "tcomponentevent" instance from sender=self,
width
+
// "kind" is defined when creating the event,
 +
// and "tag" may be adjusted after creation
 +
procedure postcomponentevent(const event: tcomponentevent);
 +
 
 +
// returns the classname of the widget if the widget is toplevel,
 +
// and "tmsecomponent" otherwise )
 +
property moduleclassname: string read getmoduleclassname;
 +
 
 +
// returns the classname of the widget as the entry of its constructor
 +
// ( button => tbutton, datamodule => tdm1mo, form => ttstfo, dbstringedit => tdbstringedit,.. )
 +
property actualclassname: string read getactualclassname;
 +
 
 +
// returns "fmsecomponentstate"
 +
// ( a set of cs_ismodule,cs_endreadproc,cs_loadedproc,cs_noload, cs_hasskin,cs_noskin )
 +
property msecomponentstate: msecomponentstatesty read fmsecomponentstate;
 +
 
 +
// returns/sets a pointer associated with the widget
 +
// ( contrary to the integer "tag", allows to use an arbitary data type
 +
// for associating data )
 +
property tagpo: pointer read ftagpo write ftagpo;
 +
 
 +
// returns/sets a string identifying the widget in the help system
 +
property helpcontext: msestring read gethelpcontext write fhelpcontext;
 +
 
 +
// twidget
 +
 
 +
// creates an instance of the widget, owned by "aowner" if not NIL
 +
constructor create(aowner: tcomponent); override;
 +
 
 +
destructor destroy; override;
 +
 
 +
// ??
 +
procedure afterconstruction; override;
 +
 
 +
// rescales the widget frame ( if assigned ) then owned widgets ( if exist, recursively ) then bounds_* then the font ( if assigned )
 +
// called before inserting in parentwidget,
 +
// calls "scale(ascale)",
 +
// no visual repainting
 +
procedure initnewcomponent(const ascale: real); virtual;
 +
 
 +
// restores the "fontheight" to "font.glyphheight" if "ow_fontglyphheight" or
 +
// to "font.lineheight" if "ow_fontlineheight" otherwise,
 +
// ascale is ignored ?
 +
// calls "synctofontheight->setfontheight",
 +
// called after inserting in parentwidget,
 +
// no visual repainting
 +
procedure initnewwidget(const ascale: real); virtual;
 +
 
 +
// creates the widget frame if not yet created
 +
procedure createframe;
 +
 
 +
// creates the widget face if not yet  created
 +
procedure createface;
 +
 
 +
// creates the widget font if not yet  created
 +
procedure createfont;
 +
 
 +
// checks ws_loadlock and csdestroing too
 +
function isloading: boolean;
 +
 
 +
// returns "widgetstatety" - a set of (
 +
// ws_visible,ws_enabled,ws_active,ws_entered,ws_entering,ws_exiting,
 +
// ws_focused,ws_mouseinclient,ws_wantmousebutton,ws_wantmousemove,
 +
// ws_wantmousefocus,ws_iswidget,ws_opaque,ws_nopaint,
 +
// ws_clicked,ws_mousecaptured,ws_clientmousecaptured,
 +
// ws_loadlock,ws_loadedproc,ws_showproc,ws_minclientsizevalid,
 +
// ws_showed,ws_hidden, //used in tcustomeventwidget
 +
// ws_destroying,ws_staticframe,ws_staticface,ws_isvisible
 +
//
 +
// iframe
 +
function widgetstate: widgetstatesty;
 +
 
 +
// returns "widgetstate1ty" - a set of (
 +
// (ws1_childscaled,ws1_fontheightlock,
 +
// ws1_widgetregionvalid,ws1_rootvalid,
 +
// ws1_anchorsizing,ws1_isstreamed,
 +
// ws1_scaled, //used in tcustomscalingwidget
 +
// ws1_noclipchildren,
 +
// ws1_nodesignvisible,ws1_nodesignframe,ws1_nodesignhandles,
 +
// ws1_nodesigndelete,ws1_designactive,
 +
// ws1_fakevisible,ws1_nominsize //used for report size calculations
 +
// )
 +
property widgetstate1: widgetstates1ty read fwidgetstate1;
 +
 +
* this set of states is needed because the max FPC set size is 32
 +
  thus "widgetstate1ty" can't fit all states
 +
 
 +
// TRUE if the widget is contained within another widget
 +
// ( tcomponent stuff )
 +
function hasparent: boolean; override;             
 +
 
 +
// returns the parent component if it's a widget or the grandparent otherwise
 +
function getparentcomponent: tcomponent; override;  // tcomponent
 +
 
 +
// TRUE if "awidget" is an ascendant or the widget or they are the same widget
 +
function checkdescendent(awidget: twidget): boolean;
 +
 +
// TRUE if app is running and the widget owns the caret or the caret widget
 +
function hascaret: boolean;
 +
 
 +
        // TRUE if "winid" allocated and not loading and not destroying,
 +
        // all widgets on a form have "winid" of this form ( a real window allocated by the OS )
 +
        // thus have this function TRUE
 +
function windowallocated: boolean;
 +
 
 +
// TRUE if presents a valid toplevelwindow with assigned "winid"
 +
function ownswindow: boolean;
 +
 
 +
// invalidated area of the widget, the origin is "clientpos" against the roor widget
 +
function updaterect: rectty;
 +
 
 +
// calls recursively "canclose" for all contained widgets ( the widget oneself excluded! ),
 +
// TRUE if none of the widgets return FALSE
 +
//
 +
// more specialized widgets may have "canclose" overridden
 +
// to perform more work than just this call recursion
 +
// ( not null or range check,.. )
 +
//
 +
// "onclosequery" must also pass the check if assigned, for the function to succeed
 +
function canclose(const newfocus: twidget = nil): boolean; virtual;
 +
 
 +
        // checks "canclose" first for focused widget of the window ( form,.. )
 +
        // if it is a descendant of the widget or the widget oneself,
 +
        // then continues with subwidgets of the widget;
 +
        // also - finishes editing ( snapshots "value" ) in the focused widget before checking
 +
function canparentclose(const newfocus: twidget): boolean; overload;
 +
 
 +
// the above function but with the preserved focus
 +
function canparentclose: boolean; overload;
 +
                  //newfocus = window.focusedwidget     
 +
 
 +
function canfocus: boolean; virtual;
 +
function setfocus(aactivate: boolean = true): boolean; virtual;//true if ok
 +
procedure nextfocus; //sets inputfocus to then next appropriate widget
 +
 
 +
function findtabfocus(const ataborder: integer): twidget;
 +
                      //nil if cannot focus
 +
 
 +
function firsttabfocus: twidget;
 +
function lasttabfocus: twidget;
 +
function nexttaborder(const down: boolean = false): twidget;
 +
 
 +
function focusback(const aactivate: boolean = true): boolean;
 +
                              //false if focus not changed
 +
 
 +
function parentcolor: colorty;
 +
function actualcolor: colorty; virtual;
 +
function actualopaquecolor: colorty;
 +
function backgroundcolor: colorty;
 +
function translatecolor(const acolor: colorty): colorty;
 +
 
 +
procedure widgetevent(const event: twidgetevent); virtual;
 +
 
 +
procedure sendwidgetevent(const event: twidgetevent);
 +
                              //event will be destroyed
 +
 
 +
procedure release; override;
 +
 
 +
function show(const modal: boolean = false; const transientfor: twindow = nil): modalresultty; virtual;
 +
 
 +
procedure hide;
 +
procedure activate(const abringtofront: boolean = true); virtual;
 +
                            //show and setfocus
 +
 
 +
procedure bringtofront;
 +
procedure sendtoback;
 +
procedure stackunder(const predecessor: twidget);
 +
 
 +
procedure paint(const canvas: tcanvas); virtual;
 +
procedure update; virtual;
 +
procedure scrollwidgets(const dist: pointty);
 +
 
 +
procedure scrollrect(const dist: pointty; const rect: rectty; scrollcaret: boolean);
 +
                            //origin = paintrect.pos
 +
 
 +
procedure scroll(const dist: pointty);
 +
                            //scrolls paintrect and widgets
 +
 
 +
procedure getcaret;
 +
procedure scrollcaret(const dist: pointty);
 +
function mousecaptured: boolean;
 +
procedure capturemouse(grab: boolean = true);
 +
procedure releasemouse;
 +
procedure capturekeyboard;
 +
procedure releasekeyboard;
 +
procedure synctofontheight; virtual;
 +
 
 +
procedure dragevent(var info: draginfoty); virtual;
 +
procedure dochildscaled(const sender: twidget); virtual;
 +
 
 +
procedure invalidatewidget;    //invalidates whole widget
 +
procedure invalidate;          //invalidates clientrect
 +
procedure invalidaterect(const rect: rectty; org: originty = org_client);
 +
procedure invalidateframestate;
 +
 
 +
procedure invalidateframestaterect(const rect: rectty;
 +
                                        const org: originty = org_client); 
 +
function hasoverlappingsiblings(arect: rectty): boolean; //origin = pos
 +
 
 +
function window: twindow;
 +
function rootwidget: twidget;
 +
 
 +
function parentofcontainer: twidget;
 +
            //parentwidget.parentwidget if parentwidget has not ws_iswidget,
 +
            //parentwidget otherwise
 +
 
 +
property parentwidget: twidget read fparentwidget write setparentwidget;
 +
function getrootwidgetpath: widgetarty; //root widget is last
 +
 
 +
// number of contained widgets ( the widget oneself excluded ! )
 +
function widgetcount: integer;
 +
 
 +
function parentwidgetindex: integer; //index in parentwidget.widgets, -1 if none
 +
property widgets[const index: integer]: twidget read getwidgets;
 +
function widgetatpos(var info: widgetatposinfoty): twidget; overload;
 +
function widgetatpos(const pos: pointty): twidget; overload;
 +
 
 +
function widgetatpos(const pos: pointty;
 +
                  const state: widgetstatesty): twidget; overload;
 +
 
 +
property taborderedwidgets: widgetarty read gettaborderedwidgets;
 +
 
 +
function findtagwidget(const atag: integer; const aclass: widgetclassty): twidget;
 +
              //returns first matching descendent
 +
 
 +
property container: twidget read getcontainer;
 +
function containeroffset: pointty;
 +
function childrencount: integer; virtual;
 +
property children[const index: integer]: twidget read getchildwidgets; default;
 +
 
 +
function childatpos(const pos: pointty;
 +
                  const clientorigin: boolean = true): twidget; virtual;
 +
 
 +
function getsortxchildren: widgetarty;
 +
function getsortychildren: widgetarty;
 +
property focusedchild: twidget read ffocusedchild;
 +
property focusedchildbefore: twidget read ffocusedchildbefore;
 +
 
 +
function mouseeventwidget(const info: mouseeventinfoty): twidget;
 +
 
 +
function checkdescendent(widget: twidget): boolean;
 +
                    //true if widget is descendent or self
 +
 
 +
function checkancestor(widget: twidget): boolean;
 +
                    //true if widget is ancestor or self
 +
 
 +
function containswidget(awidget: twidget): boolean;
 +
 
 +
procedure insertwidget(const awidget: twidget); overload;
 +
 
 +
procedure insertwidget(const awidget: twidget; const apos: pointty); overload; virtual;
 +
                //widget can be child
 +
 
 +
function iswidgetclick(const info: mouseeventinfoty; const caption: boolean = false): boolean;
 +
//true if eventtype = et_butonrelease, button is mb_left, clicked and pos in clientrect
 +
//or in frame.caption if caption = true, origin = pos
 +
 
 +
function isclick(const info: mouseeventinfoty): boolean;
 +
//true if eventtype = et_butonrelease, button is mb_left, clicked and pos in clientrect
 +
 
 +
function isdblclick(const info: mouseeventinfoty): boolean;
 +
//true if eventtype = et_butonpress, button is mb_left, pos in clientrect
 +
// and timedlay to last buttonpress is short
 +
 
 +
function isdblclicked(const info: mouseeventinfoty): boolean;
 +
//true if eventtype in [et_buttonpress,et_butonrelease], button is mb_left,
 +
// and timedlay to last same buttonevent is short
 +
 
 +
function isleftbuttondown(const info: mouseeventinfoty): boolean;
 +
//true if eventtype = et_butonpress, button is mb_left, pos in clientrect
 +
//origin = paintrect.pos
 +
 
 +
widgetrect: the widget on-screen area including its frame & frame caption
 +
 
 +
paintrect: the widget on-screen area except its frame & frame caption
 +
 
 +
clientrect: virtual area which
 +
- for non-scrolling widgets, equals to "paintrect", with its "pos:= (0,0)"
 +
- for scrolling widgets, may be bigger than "paintrect",
 +
  also may shift ( change its "pos" ) when scrolling
 +
 +
// the coord of outer top-left corner against the toplevel form = the window owner,
 +
// including the frame & frame caption
 +
function rootpos: pointty;
 +
 
 +
// the coord of the outer top-left corner against the screen ( the WM decorations aren't counted in )
 +
// includes the frame & frame caption
 +
property screenpos: pointty;
 +
 
 +
//  the coord of the outer top-left corner against the parent widget,
 +
// including the frame & frame caption
 +
property widgetrect: rectty;
 +
property pos: pointty; // =widgetrect.pos
 +
property size: sizety; // =widgetrect.size
 +
property left: integer; // =bounds_x
 +
property right: integer; //widgetrect.x + widgetrect.cx, sets cx;
 +
property top: integer;  // =bounds_y
 +
property bottom: integer; //widgetrect.y + widgetrect.cy, sets cy;
 +
property width: integer; // =bounds_cx
 +
property height: integer; // =bounds_cy
 +
function widgetsizerect: rectty;          //pos = nullpoint
 +
 
 +
    // the coord of the paint area ( paintrect ) against own outer top-left corner ( against "widgetrect=pos" )
 +
    //  except the frame & frame caption
 +
function paintrect: rectty;
 +
function paintpos: pointty;
 +
function paintsize: sizety;
 +
function innerpaintrect: rectty; // mainly equals to paintrect
 +
function clientwidgetrect: rectty; // mainly equals to paintrect
 +
function clientwidgetpos: pointty;
 +
function clippedpaintrect: rectty; // mainly equals to  but clipped by all parentpaintrects
 +
function innerwidgetrect: rectty;    // mainly equals to paintrect
 +
function innerclientwidgetpos: pointty;
 +
 
 +
    // the coord of the paint area ( paintrect ) against own outer top-left corner ( against "widgetrect=pos" )
 +
    //  except the frame caption
 +
function framerect: rectty; // =paintrect except the frame caption area
 +
function framepos: pointty;
 +
function framesize: sizety;
 +
 
 +
    // the coord of the client area ( clientrect )  against the paint area ( paintrect )
 +
    //  usually these areas match
 +
function clientrect: rectty;
 +
property clientsize: sizety;
 +
property clientwidth: integer;
 +
property clientheight: integer;
 +
property clientpos: pointty;
 +
 
 +
    // the coord of the paint area of the parent against the paint area of this widget
 +
function paintrectparent: rectty; //nullrect if parent = nil,
 +
 
 +
    // the coord of the client area of the parent against the paint area of this widget
 +
function clientrectparent: rectty; //nullrect if parent = nil,
 +
 
 +
// the coord of the inner area against the client area ( clientrect )
 +
function innerclientrect: rectty;  // mainly equals to clientrect
 +
function innerclientsize: sizety;
 +
function innerclientpos: pointty;
 +
 
 +
function framewidth: sizety;              //widgetrect.size - paintrect.size
 +
function clientframewidth: sizety;        //widgetrect.size - clientrect.size
 +
function innerclientframewidth: sizety;  //widgetrect.size - innerclientrect.size
 +
function innerframewidth: sizety;        //clientrect.size - innerclientrect.size 
 +
 
 +
    // the coord of the paint area against the widgetrect(pos) of the parent
 +
function paintparentpos: pointty;    //origin = parentwidget.pos
 +
 
 +
    // the coord of the client area against the widgetrect(pos) of the parent
 +
function clientparentpos: pointty;  //origin = parentwidget.pos
 +
 
 +
    // the coord of the widgetrect(pos) against the client area of parent
 +
property parentclientpos: pointty;
 +
 
 +
 
 +
function clientpostowidgetpos(const apos: pointty): pointty;
 +
function widgetpostoclientpos(const apos: pointty): pointty;
 +
function widgetpostopaintpos(const apos: pointty): pointty;
 +
function paintpostowidgetpos(const apos: pointty): pointty;
 +
procedure scale(const ascale: real); virtual;
 +
 
 +
 
 +
property minsize: sizety read fminsize write setminsize;
 +
property maxsize: sizety read fmaxsize write setmaxsize;
 +
function maxclientsize: sizety; virtual;
 +
 
 +
 
 +
property anchors: anchorsty read fanchors write setanchors default defaultanchors;
 +
property defaultfocuschild: twidget read getdefaultfocuschild write setdefaultfocuschild;
 +
 
 +
 
 +
procedure changeclientsize(const delta: sizety); //asynchronous
 +
 
 +
function getcanvas(aorigin: originty = org_client): tcanvas;
 +
 
 +
function showing: boolean;
 +
              //true if self and all ancestors visible and window allocated
 +
 
 +
function isenabled: boolean;
 +
              //true if self and all ancestors enabled
 +
 
 +
function active: boolean;
 +
function entered: boolean;
 +
 
 +
function activeentered: boolean;
 +
//true if entered and window is regularactivewindow or inactivated
 +
 
 +
function focused: boolean;
 +
function clicked: boolean;
 +
 
 +
function indexofwidget(const awidget: twidget): integer;
 +
 
 +
procedure changedirection(const avalue: graphicdirectionty;
 +
                                            var dest: graphicdirectionty); virtual;
 +
 
 +
// (re)arranges "awidgets" horizontally within the parent's client area
 +
// so that awidget[i] were placed next each other
 +
// at h-space dist[i], starting from "startx" with the right margin "endmargin";
 +
//
 +
// if the number of "dist" is fewer than the number of "awidgets" then the remaining h-spaces are taken
 +
// as the last "dist[i]" or "0" if none;
 +
// if the number of "dist" is more than the number of "awidgets" then the extra dist[i] are discarded
 +
//
 +
// non-zero "endmargin" causes one of awdidget[i] to h-resize to provide the margin :
 +
//  - if one or more of awidgets[i] have [an_left,an_right] set then the first of such is resized
 +
//    otherwise the last awidgets[i] is h-resized
 +
//
 +
procedure placexorder(
 +
const startx: integer;
 +
const dist: array of integer;
 +
                const awidgets: array of twidget;
 +
                const endmargin: integer = minint);
 +
 
 +
// (re)arranges "awidgets" vertically within the parent's client area
 +
// so that awidget[i] were placed upper/lower each other
 +
// at v-space dist[i], starting from "starty" with the bottom margin "endmargin";
 +
//
 +
// if the number of "dist" is fewer than the number of "awidgets" then the remaining v-spaces are taken
 +
// as the last "dist[i]" or "0" if none;
 +
// if the number of "dist" is more than the number of "awidgets" then the extra dist[i] are discarded
 +
//
 +
// non-zero "endmargin" causes one of awdidget[i] to v-resize to provide the margin :
 +
//  - if one or more of awidgets[i] have [an_top,an_bottom] set then the first of such is resized
 +
//    otherwise the last awidgets[i] is v-resized
 +
//
 +
procedure placeyorder(
 +
const starty: integer;
 +
const dist: array of integer;
 +
                const awidgets: array of twidget;
 +
                const endmargin: integer = minint);
 +
              //origin = clientpos, endmargin by size adjust of widgets
 +
              //with [an_top,an_bottom], minint -> no change
 +
 
 +
// if {mode <> wam_none} then (re)arranges "awidgets" horizontally  within the parent's client area so that
 +
// awidgets[0] stays on its place but awidgets[1..N] :
 +
// - if {mode = wam_end} then awidgets[i>=1] move or resize ( if "anchors.al_left" set ) so that they right borders match the right border of awidgets[0]
 +
// - if {mode = wam_start} then awidgets[i>=1] move or resize ( if "anchors.al_right" set ) so that they left borders match the left border of awidgets[0]
 +
// - if {mode = wam_center} then awidgets[i>=1] move so that they Y-axes match the Y-axe of awidgets[0]
 +
//
 +
// mainly applicable for v-stacked widgets since h-stacked may overlap after such alignment
 +
//
 +
        // returns the reference point ( the coord of awidgets[0] )
 +
function alignx(const mode: widgetalignmodety;
 +
                        const awidgets: array of twidget): integer;
 +
 
 +
 
 +
// if {mode <> wam_none} then (re)arranges "awidgets" vertically within the parent's client area so that
 +
// awidgets[0] stays on its place but awidgets[1..N] :
 +
// - if {mode = wam_end} then awidgets[i>=1] move or resize ( if "anchors.al_top" set ) so that they bottom borders match the bottom border of awidgets[0]
 +
// - if {mode = wam_start} then awidgets[i>=1] move or resize ( if "anchors.al_bottom" set ) so that they top borders match the top border of awidgets[0]
 +
// - if {mode = wam_center} then awidgets[i>=1] move so that they X-axes match the X-axe of awidgets[0]
 +
//
 +
// mainly applicable for h-stacked widgets since v-stacked may overlap after such alignment
 +
//
 +
        // returns the reference point ( the coord of awidgets[0] )
 +
function aligny(const mode: widgetalignmodety;
 +
                        const awidgets: array of twidget): integer;
 +
 
 +
function actualcursor: cursorshapety; virtual;
 +
 
 +
 
 +
Event handlers:
 +
 
 +
- onactivate
 +
 
 +
fires :
 +
 
 +
= on receiving input focus, just before "OnFocus"
 +
 +
= forms specific :
 +
* on 1-st display of the form after "OnLoaded" ( from "Loaded" procedure)
 +
* on switch back from another apllication/WM ( "oe_activate" event )
 +
* after closure of a descendant form
 +
* on minimizing/maximizing the form
 +
 
 +
- onchildscaled
 +
 
 +
fires :
 +
 
 +
= on child/children resizing due to font height change
 +
 
 +
= form widget: once "form.container" {scrolling widget} is loaded
 +
 
 +
- ondeactivate
 +
fires
 +
= form widget: when the form looses input focus
 +
= non-form widget: when the widget looses input focus
 +
 
 +
- ondefocus
 +
 
 +
fires
 +
= on disabling the widget
 +
 
 +
= form widget: if another form is focused
 +
= non-form widget: if another widget is focused
 +
 
 +
- onenter
 +
= fires on any way of taking parent-wide focus as soon as
 +
the parent stores the new child's order, before "OnActivate" & "OnFocus"
 +
 
 +
- onexit
 +
= fires last on parent-wide lossing focus, after "OnDefocus" & "OnDeactivate"
 +
= for top-level ( not in a container ) forms, doesn't fire
 +
 
 +
- onfocus
 +
fires
 +
= once the existing widget takes the focus
 +
= on showing the widget's form if the widget has the lowest "TabOrder"
 +
 
 +
- onfontheightdelta
 +
fires
 +
= if [ow_fontglyphheight OR ow_fontlineheight ] AND {the
 +
new font height differs from the previos one}
 +
= before the parent redraws this widget
 +
 
 +
- onpopup
 +
fires :
 +
= on calling a popup-menu ( with "RightClick" ), once the menu items of the current level are loaded
 +
( before building the submenus )
 +
 
 +
- onresize
 +
 
 +
= fires on creating/(changing size)/(min-max restoring) of widget,
 +
before actual redrawing
 +
 
 +
= rechecks if there's real work to do
 +
 
 +
- onshowhint
 +
= fires when a installed hint is activated or on "aplication.showint" called
 +
= since called last, allows to adjust the default behavior
 +
 
 +
- onbeforeupdateskin
 +
= fires in "updateskin" ( the widget is loaded etc ) before applying the skin
 +
 
 +
- onafterupdateskin
 +
= fires in "updateskin" ( the widget is loaded etc ) once the skin is applied
 +
 
 +
</pre>
 +
 
 +
=== TWidget stuff ===
 +
<pre>
 +
  Properties:   
 +
- name
 +
- anchors
 +
- bounds
 +
- color
 +
- enabled
 +
- visible
 +
- <face> : see {any face}
 +
- <frame> : see {any frame}
 +
    - hint
 +
    - helpcontext
 +
    - tag
 +
    - taborder
 +
    - cursor
 +
    - optionswidget
 +
    - optionsskin
 +
    - popupmenu
 +
   
 +
twidget's event handlers:
 +
   
 +
- on(de)activate
 +
- onbeforeupdateskin
 +
- onafterupdateskin
 +
- onchildscaled
 +
- onfontheightdelta
 +
- on(de)focus
 +
- onenter
 +
- onmove
 +
- onpopup
 +
- onresize
 +
- onshowhint
 +
     
 +
align_glue :
 +
  ( outer anchoring mode for widget group, in the align mode )
 +
- wam_none
 +
- wam_start
 +
- wan_center
 +
- wm_end
 +
 
 +
align_leader :
 +
the widget ( incl another spacer, splitter or layouter ) against which the alignment applies ( the reference widget )
 +
 
 +
align_mode :
 +
  ( inner anchoring mode within widget group, in the align mode )
 +
- wam_none
 +
- wam_start
 +
- wan_center
 +
- wm_end
 +
 
 +
// Place mode:
 +
 
 +
     
 +
place_mindist, place_maxdist:
 +
- in the place(ment) mode, limits distance between widgets
 +
  ( these distance once calculated also define side margins if applicable )
 +
 
 +
place_mode:
 +
  ( outer anchoring mode for widget group, in the place mode )
 +
- wam_none
 +
- wam_start
 +
- wan_center
 +
- wm_end
 +
 
 +
place_options:
 +
- plo_endmargin
 +
= to resize a widget so that it "eats" extra space if it occurs
 +
 +
* only applicable in the place mode, with a limiting value of "place_maxdist" and:
 +
 
 +
  1) {place_mode <> wam_none}
 +
or
 +
  2) {place_mode = wam_end} and {plo_propmargin in place_options}
 +
 
 +
For the exact look, see above
 +
 
 +
 
 +
- plo_propmargin
 +
= виджеты расставляются теснее так, чтобы образовались отступы перед и после,
 +
  причем расстояние между центрами виджетов было бы таким же,
 +
  как и растояние между серединами крайних виджетов и соотв. границами зоны расстановки
 +
 
 +
- plo_syncmaxautosize
 +
= see above
 +
 
 +
- plo_synccaptiondistx
 +
= see above
 +
 
 +
  * affects widgets with opposite cp_left/right set as well
 +
  * the minimal before-adjustment "captiondist" among all widgets limits "captiondist" for each of the widget
 +
              * don't set cfo_captiondistouter here !
 +
 
 +
- plo_synccaptiondisty
 +
= see above
 +
 
 +
  * affects also widgets with opposite cp_top/bottom set
 +
  * the minimal before-adjustment "captiondist" amongst all widgets limits "captiondist" for each of the widget
 +
 
 +
              ! here, don't set "cfo_captiondistouter" for affected widgets !
 +
 
 +
- plo_syncpaintwidth
 +
= see above
 +
 
 +
- plo_syncpaintheight
 +
= see above
 +
 
 +
- plo_scalesize
 +
= see above
 +
 
 +
 
 +
dist_left, dist_right, dist_top, dist_bottom :
 +
= margins between most outer edge the layouter and
 +
  the corresponding linked widget
 +
 
 +
* see "tspacer" for detail
 +
 
 +
linkleft,linkright,linktop,linkbottom : see "tspacer"
 +
 
 +
options:
 +
- spao_glueright, spao_gluebottom:
 +
= set the adjustment dependencies between the layouter and its link_* widgets
 +
 
 +
* see "tspacer" for more details
 +
 
 +
// which mode of widget placement to apply - see above
 +
optionslayout:
 +
- lao_alignx
 +
- lao_aligny
 +
- lao_placex
 +
- lao_placey
 +
- lao_scalewidth
 +
- lao_scaleheight
 +
- lao_scaleleft
 +
- lao_scaletop
 +
 +
* lao_place* & lao_align* can't be combined for one direction
 +
 
 +
optionsscale:
 +
 
 +
  * cause the layouter to provide full space for the widgets as long as they expand/shrink/move
 +
 
 +
- osc_expandx
 +
= allocates more h-space if needed
 +
 
 +
- osc_shrinkx
 +
= removes extra h-space if occurred
 +
 
 +
- osc_expandy
 +
= allocates more v-space if needed
 +
 
 +
- osc_shrinky
 +
= removes extra v-space if occurred
 +
 
 +
- osc_invisishrinkx
 +
= fully h-collapses the layouter if "visible=false" ( run-time only )
 +
 
 +
- osc_invisishrinky
 +
= fully v-collapses the layoter if "visible=false" ( run-time only )
 +
 
 +
optionsskin:
 +
= see <any widget>
 +
 
 +
 
 +
Methods:
 +
 
 +
constructor create(aowner: tcomponent); override;
 +
</pre>
 +
 
 +
=== Public stuff ===
 +
<pre>
 +
(f)window:
 +
the OS-allocated ( root = toplevel ) window common for all widgets of this window
 +
 +
* "widget.fwindow.fowner = widget.self" in case of the widget present the root "fwindow"
 +
  ( owns the window )
 +
 
 +
(f)rootpos:
 +
position of the widget in the coord of toplevel window not the nearest parent widget alone,
 +
calculated as sum of such positions ( fwidgetrect.pos ) starting from the toplevel through the
 +
                chain of all parents up to the current widget;
 +
"nullpoint" (0,0) for toplevel widgets ( window-owning forms,..)
 +
 
 +
screenpos:
 +
- coord aginst the top-left corner of screen
 +
- WM decoration & title aren't parts of the widget !
 +
 
 +
widgetrect:
 +
the widget on-screen area including its frame & frame caption
 +
 
 +
paintrect:
 +
the widget on-screen area except its frame & frame caption
 +
 
 +
clientrect:
 +
virtual area which
 +
- for non-scrolling widgets, equals to "paintrect", with its "pos:= (0,0)"
 +
- for scrolling widgets, may be bigger than "paintrect",
 +
  also may shift ( change its "pos" ) when scrolling
 +
 
 +
* "t*grid" aren't such scrollable widgets since their virtual height would be limited by
 +
  the X11 "+-32000" limitation,
 +
  so example of such widgets are tscrollbox, "tform.container" etc
 +
 
 +
framerect:
 +
the widget on-screen area except its frame caption but including inner & outer frame
 +
 
 +
****************
 +
 
 +
// releases all thread locks then post the event to the app event queue and
 +
// waits for the event handler finishes ( signalled by "sye_ok on a semaphore )
 +
// finally restores the locks
 +
    // true if the handler is not aborted
 +
function synchronizeevent(const aevent: tsynchronizeevent): boolean;
 +
 
 +
    // translates "point" coord against "source" widgetrect to "dest" widgetrect
 +
//
 +
//  * nil "source" = from screen coord
 +
//  * nil "dest" = to screen coord
 +
procedure translatewidgetpoint1(var point: pointty; const source,dest: twidget);
 +
 
 +
// the function-framed version of "translatewidgetpoint1"
 +
function translatewidgetpoint(const point: pointty; const source,dest: twidget): pointty;
 +
 
 +
// rect isntead of point,
 +
// if dest = nil then to screen
 +
    // if source = nil then against screen
 +
function translatewidgetrect(const rect: rectty; const source,dest: twidget): rectty;
 +
//-----------------
 +
    // translates "point" coord against "source" paintrect to "dest" paintrect
 +
//  * nil "source" = from screen coord
 +
//  * nil "dest" = to screen coord
 +
procedure translatepaintpoint1(var point: pointty; const source,dest: twidget);
 +
 
 +
// the function-framed version of "translatepaintpoint1"
 +
function translatepaintpoint(const point: pointty; const source,dest: twidget): pointty;
 +
 
 +
// rect isntead of point,
 +
// if dest = nil then to screen
 +
    // if source = nil then against screen
 +
function translatepaintrect(const rect: rectty;const source,dest: twidget): rectty;
 +
    //-----------------
 +
    // translates "point" coord against "source" clientrect to "dest" clienttrect
 +
//  * nil "source" = from screen coord
 +
//  * nil "dest" = to screen coord
 +
procedure translateclientpoint1(var point: pointty;
 +
                    const source,dest: twidget);
 +
 
 +
// the function-framed version of "translateclientpoint1"
 +
function translateclientpoint(const point: pointty; const source,dest: twidget): pointty;
 +
 
 +
// rect isntead of point,
 +
// if dest = nil then to screen
 +
    // if source = nil then against screen
 +
function translateclientrect(const rect: rectty; const source,dest: twidget): rectty;
 +
    //-----------------
 +
 
 +
// (re)sorts "awidgets" in order of increasing their "widgetrect.x" coords
 +
//  - if parent = nil then the coords are against individual parent of each of "awidgets"
 +
//  - if parent is supplied then the coords are against this parent
 +
procedure sortwidgetsxorder(var awidgets: widgetarty; const parent: twidget = nil);
 +
 
 +
// (re)sorts "awidgets" in order of increasing their "widgetrect.y" coords
 +
//  - if parent = nil then the coords are against individual parent of each of "awidgets"
 +
//  - if parent is supplied then the coords are against this parent
 +
procedure sortwidgetsyorder(var awidgets: widgetarty; const parent: twidget = nil);
 +
 
 +
// for each  of "widgets", calculates its autosized client area ( min size rect to fit the caption, etc )
 +
    //  - both hor & ver sizes of client area of each of "widgets" are adjusted to the max of the above calculated areas,
 +
//   as the result - client areas of all widgets become identically v+h sized
 +
    //
 +
    //  * right & bottom anchored margins of each widget are preserved
 +
procedure syncmaxautosize(const widgets: array of twidget);
 +
 
 +
// for each  of "widgets", width of client area of each of "widgets" is adjusted so that
 +
    // external ( by the outer border of frame ) widths of all widgets become identical
 +
    // to the external widht of the widest widget
 +
    //   
 +
    //  * if "awidth" >= 0 then no determining the widest widget is taken and
 +
    //    "awidth" is adjusted to instead, for all widgets
 +
    //  * right anchored margins of each widget are lost
 +
procedure syncminframewidth(const awidgets: array of twidget;
 +
                              const awidth: integer = -1);
 +
 
 +
// for each  of "widgets", height of client area of each of "widgets" is adjusted so that
 +
    // external ( by the outer border of frame ) heights of all widgets become identical
 +
    // to the external height of the highest widget
 +
    //   
 +
    //  * if "aheight" >= 0 then no determining the highest widget is taken and
 +
    //    "aheight" is adjusted to instead, for all widgets
 +
    //  * bottom anchored margins of each widget are lost
 +
procedure syncminframeheight(const awidgets: array of twidget; const aheight: integer = -1);
 +
</pre>
  
items[N]
+
== Projects using MSEgui ==
color
 
colorselect
 
datalist - ???
 
face - see <any face>
 
fontselect - see <any font>
 
frame - see <any frame>
 
linecolor
 
linecolorfix
 
linewidth
 
name
 
 
options
 
 
<pre/>
 
=== Report ===
 
  
==== TRepSpacer ====
+
* [[Projects using MSEgui]]
==== TRecordBand ====
 
==== TrepValueDisp ====
 
==== TRepPageNumdisp ====
 
==== TRepPrintDateDisp ====
 
==== TBandGroup ====
 
==== TTileArea ====
 
 
 
== Design ==
 
 
 
=== TGdbMi ===
 
=== TSyntaxEdit ===
 
=== TSyntaxPainter ===
 
 
 
== Comm ==
 
 
 
=== TCommPort ===
 
=== TAsciiCommPort ===
 
=== TAsciiProtPort ===
 
=== TCommSelector ===
 

Latest revision as of 00:07, 10 April 2021

English (en)

Widgets

TSimpleWidget

see also Reference:_MSEgui/TSimpleWidget

TMainMenuWidget

TSimpleWidget

TMseFormWidget

Use it in order to insert a tcustomform descendant into another widget at designtime. Does not try to load resources in "create".

        tmseform descendants ( MainForm, SimpleForm,.. )

	Client area of the form & parent of its widgets ( against which the widgets 
	are placed and colored ) is presented by the "container" property 
	not "container.frame.clientarea"

	CanClose is called :

		- on receiving "ek_close" by window
		- for modal window, on focus change

		- within parent window's "CanClose"	where all nested windows are  
		checked for OnCloseQuery & OnClose - if any sets "mr_none" then the parent window 
		can't close as well
			
		- from nested window's "CanParentClose"
		- from own "CanParentClose"

		- some componnets build oneself in own "Loaded" procedure :
			= widget grids
			= database access components
			= ...

	The "form.show" has parameter "transientfor".
	The window Z-order is above the "transientfor" window. The exact behaviour
	depends on the window manager.
        
        caption
		- run-time caption on the title bar

	color
		- color behind the client ( contaner ) area

	container
		- the real parent of form's widgets, <see "tformscrollbox">

	cursor
		- the mouse over cursor shape

	enabled - "false" disables all child widgets

	face
		<see "tfacecomp"> + some more options

	font
		<see "tfont">

	frame
		<see "tframecomp"> + some more options
		
	icon 
		<see "timage">

	mainmenu
		<see tmainmenu>

	name
		- name to refer when programming

	options:

		fo_main 
			- assigns this from as the aplication GUI-face & event receiver
			- causes the icon of this form to be icon of the application 

		fo_terminateonclose
			- causes the application to terminate once the form has closed ( doesn't depend on "fo_main" )


		fo_freeonclose
			- causes the form (even being modal) to release its memory on closure or OK-return from "CanClose"

		fo_defaultpos
			- lets the WM to position the form initially

		fo_screencentered
			- causes the form initially to show in center of the apllication work area

		fo_closeonesc
			- causes the form to close on "Esc" key pressed ( with MR_ESCAPE & "OnCloseQuery" firing )

		fo_cancelonesc
			- causes the form to close on "Esc" key pressed ( with MR_CANCEL & "OnCloseQuery" firing )

		fo_closeonenter
			- causes the form to close on "Enter" key pressed ( with MR_OK & "OnCloseQuery" firing )

		fo_closeonf10
			- causes the form to close on "F10" key pressed ( with MR_F10 & "OnCloseQuery" firing )

		fo_globalshortcuts
			- allows on-this-form "ao_globalshortcut" actions to trigger

			  Notes :
				= shortcuts for modal not "fo_localshortcut" forms are processed by app
				= shortcuts for "fo_globalshorcut" forms are processed by the owning window 

		fo_localshortcuts
			- disables triggering shortcuts of on-this-form actions

		fo_autoreadstat
			- for "cs_ismodule" forms, before "OnLoaded" fires, rereads all statvars from the bound stafile/memorystream

		fo_autowritestat
			- in "CanClose", after "OnClose" fires [ and before app termination for "fo_terminateonlose" form ], 
			rewrites all statvars to the stafile/memorystream
			- for datamodules, does this before "OnDestroy" fires

		fo_savepos
			- saves/restores Z-order, size & scree coordinates of the form 
			as soon as the stat data are ready

		fo_savestate
			- for top-level form, saves/restores "VSize", "Active" & "Visible" 
			as soon as the stat data are ready

	optionswidget
		<see "any widget">
	optionswindow
		<see "any window">
	popupmenu
		<see "tpopupmenu">
	stafile
		<see "tstafile">
	stavarname
	taborder
	tag

	visible - for a form, only affects its childs widgets

	Events:

		activate = to set focused & redraw the invalidated area

		oncreate
			- fires before "Loaded" procedure is called
			- fires after creating the widget & its subwidgets but before the final arrangement
			- forms arent' yet visible on return

		  Since "Loaded" procedure hasn't yet worked at this point then 
			database contents, values of widget grid's subwidgets 
			are invalid in this event ***

		onloaded
			- fires once "Loaded" procedure of owns & all form's widgets finishes
			- processed  after "OnCreate"
			- on finishing, forms aren't yet visible

		oneventloopstart ( main forms only )
			- only applicable to main forms
			- fires once all application GUI is built and shown 
			( and ready to user's interaction )
			
		onactivate 
			- see {any_widget.OnActivate}

		onenter
			= see {any_widget.OnEnter}

		onfocus
			- see {any_widget.OnFocus}
			

		onwindowactivechanged
			- fires on :
				= touching another window even on clicking in a behind-modal window ( or its title bar )
				= 1-st showing the window
				- reactivating the window

		onbeforepaint
			- fires at the very beginning of "paint", before drawing canvas

		onpaint
			- fires in "paint" procedure, between drawing canvas and contained widgets

		onafterpaint (doafterpaint)
			- fires just on return from "paint" procedure

        	onapplicationactivechanged 
			- fires :
				= if the application gets/looses input focus

		onasyncevent (doasyncevent)
			- fires on calling {this_form}.asyncevent(atag) from any place of the application
			once delivered by the app even queue

			 "atag" set by caller(s) helps to branch within "onasyncevent", to identify the caller, etc ***
			 generally, doesn't fire instantly because these events are delivered through the app event queue ***


		onchildmouseevent
			- fires on any mouse activity over its child widget(s) not the (containing) widget oneself

		      for forms, it even fires on enetering "container" therefore it appears as if to be the form itself ***

		onchildscaled
			- see {any_widget.OnChildScaled}

		onclientmouseevent
			- fires on any mouse activity over areas expecting user's mouse input (not titlebars/frames/...)

		onclose
			- fires in "CanClose" if "modalresult <> mr_none"

		onclosequery
			- fires in "CanClose" before "OnClose"
			- "mr_none" set on return prevents the window (and its parent) from closing 
			( "OnClose" is also bypassed )


		ondeactivate
			- see {any_widget.OnDeactivate}

		ondefocus
			- see {any_widget.OnDeFocus}
			
		ondestroy
			- fires on in-code calling "BeforeDestruction"

		ondestroyed
			- fires on return from the form's destructor ( when all resources are freed )

		onterminatequery
			- fires on an attempt to terminate the app
			- by setting "var terminate:= false", allows to cancel termination 

			 Termination by debugger/OS facilities can't be blocked this way ( win32 )***

		onterminated
			- fires for not-yet-destroyed forms, once the app event loop finishes 
			- may be caused by any closure of the main app form 
			( app termination, WM/OS facilities, )


		onwindowdestroyed
			- fires once a descendant window is destroyed 
			( for a main form, when a modal simple form is closed by any way,.. )

		onevent
			- fires on receiving an event 
				= for simple forms, it's only "ek_loaded"

			There can be more if the form is connected to object_event sending
			components or if the application uses object events, for example by calling
			tguicomponent.postcomponentevent. ****

		onexit
			- see {any_widget.OnExit}

		onfocusedwidgetchanged
			- for a "prev-new" parent-wide focused wigdets pair, fires once installing new focus has finished, 
			after "OnFocus"
			- resends for all contained widgets
			- doesn't fire if the "prev-new" pair don't really change

		onfontheightdelta
			- see {any_widget.OnFontHeightDelta}

		onhide
			- fires at beginnig of own/parent's 
				= hide
				= hidden
				= destroying
				= setting "visible:= false"
				= closing the window ( receiving event "ek_close",.. )
				= calling "window.close" 
				
		onidle
			- fires everytime when the app GUI event queue gets empty
			- to stop calling for a while, set "again" parameter to "false" (the initial value );
			
			 DON'T DO ANYTHING AFFECTING THE APP EVENT QUEUE ( MODAL WINDOWS, "ShowMessage", Sleep(N),... ) IN THIS HANDLER. 
				MODAL WINDOWS CAUSE RECURSION ! 
			
			A code fragment:

				again:= i < 5;
				if not again then exit;

		onkeydown
			- fires on pressing down a keyboard key over the client area when none of child widgets is focused

		onkeyup
			- fires on releasing a keyboard key over the client area when none of child widgets is focused

		onmouseevent
			- fires on any mouse activity over the client area

		onmove
			- see {any_window.OnMove}

		onpopup
			- see {any_widget.OnPopup}

		onresize
			- see {any_widget.OnResize}

		onshortcut
			- fires before built-in shorcut processing
			- "info.eventstate=es_processed" set in "OnShortcut" prevents 
			the event from further auto-processing

			The app 
				- recognizes & takes registered shortcuts from app event queue
				- passes the shocrcut event to each of its windows until the event 
				is processed otherwise processes it by oneself 
			

		onshow
			- fires if the widget is visible:
				= on calling "Show" method
				= on return from "Loaded" procedure
				= on showing the parent widget
			- since called at end, allows to adjust the default behavior

		onshowhint
			- see {any_widget.OnShowHint}

		onstatbeforeread 
			- fires before loading statvars  from the disk file

		onstatafterread
			- fires once statvars are loaded from the disk file

		onstatupdate 
			- fires at 1-st stage before updating GUI "state/pos" for read statvars
			or 
			- fires at pre-last stage before saving GUI "state/pos"

		onstatread 
			- fires at 2-nd stage before updating GUI "state/pos" for read statvars

		onstatwrite
			- fires at last stage before saving GUI "state/pos"

		pon stat reading, non-minimized visible windows are shown, 
		the active window is activated 

TDockFormWidget

TPaintbox

How to draw line (or circle) on tpaintbox? In event onpaint:

 
 procedure tmainfo.paintboxonpaint(const sender: twidget; const canvas: tcanvas); 
 begin 
  with sender,canvas do begin 
   drawline(nullpoint,pointty(size),cl_yellow);  
   //diagonal line across widget 
   drawellipse(makerect(makepoint(bounds_cx div 2,bounds_cy div 2), size),cl_red); 
   //circle (or ellipse) centered in widget                             
  end; 
 end;

Makepoint and makerect are in msegraphutils.

TEventWidget

A widget which publishes all possible events of a twidget. Normally it is better to implement your own specialized descendant of an existing widget instead to use teventwidget.

TButton

  • A rectangular clickable area that can show text/bitmap.

- Main properties:

Caption: read/write the text that appear on top of it.
onexecute: read/write the address of a procedure (event handler) to be executed when clicked.

TStockGlyphButton

TRichButton

TLabel

  • Draws a piece of text on the given surface (canvas: screen/printer/bitmap).

- Main properties:

Caption: read/write the piece of text.

See also TLabel

TGroupBox

TStepBox

TStringDisp

  • A read only version of TStringEdit, difference from TLabel: has a frame around it.

-Main properties:

Value: read/write the text that are showed.
Caption: A label normally describing the purpose or meaning of the presented text, it can be positioned around the frame.

TByteStringDisp

TIntegerDisp

TRealDisp

TDateTimeDisp

TBooleanDisp

TToolBar

TDrawGrid

TStringGrid

TTabBar

TTabPage

TTabWidget

TDockHandle

TDockPanel

TSpliter

	       A widget very similar to "tspacer" but :
		- designed to rearrange areas occupied by adjacent widgets
		- a linked widget may only enlarge by "eating" the opposite one, 
		so the summary area of both widgets don't change
		- has GUI look ( hatched grip, color etc) switched on by default
		- facilitates run-time repositioning oneself and linked widgets
		- linked widgets may even be other splitters, spacers (with their linked widgets ),..
	
        Properties:

	- color
		= see {any_widget.color}

	- cursor
		= see {any_widget.cursor}

	- enabled
		= "false" stops user interaction

	- face
		= see {any_face}

	- frame
		= see {any_frame}

	- colorgrip
		= color of grip hatching

	- grip
		= defines hatching pattern of the grip

			* stb_dens(N) : the pattern is of rhombuses, the painted rhombs occupy "N" persents of the grip

			* stb_block(N) : the pattern is of squares, painted & unpainted squares are equally sized and 
			both have "N" pixels sides
			
			* stb_hatchup(N) : the pattern is of right-tilted lines of 1 pixel width,
			each "N"-th pixel forms these lines

			* stb_hatchdown(N) : the pattern is of left-tilted lines of 1 pixel width,
			each "N"-th pixel forms these lines

			* stb_crosshatch(N) : the pattern is of crossing (left & right) tilted lines of 1 pixel width,
			each "N"-th pixel forms these lines


	- linkbottom/linkleft/linkright/linktop 
		= see {tspacer.*}

	- options

		= spo_hmove
			* "true" allows the spliter to move horizontally

		= spo_hprop
			* "true" : keep the left position proportional ( on the ratio of creation time ) 
			to weigth of the client area of parent

		= spo_hsizeprop
			* "true" : keep width of the spacer proportional ( on the ratio of creation time ) 
			to weigth of the client area of parent
			* the width stops shrinking on one set in design time

		= spo_vmove
			* "true" allows the spliter to move vertically

		= spo_vprop
			* "true" : keep the top position proportional ( on the ratio of creation time ) 
			to height of the client area of parent

		= spo_vsizeprop
			* "true" : keep height of the spacer proportional ( on the ratio of creation time ) 
			to height of the client area of parent
			* the height stops shrinking on one set in design time

		= spo_dockleft
			* causes the "linkleft" widget to dock to the left border of splitter
			* make sence only if linkleft "widget.bounds_x" less than "splitter.bounds_x"

		= spo_docktop
			* causes the "linktop" widget to dock to the top border of splitter
			* make sence only if linktop "widget.bounds_y" less than "splitter.bounds_y"

		= spo_dockright
			* causes the "linkright" widget to dock to the right border of splitter
			* make sence only if linkright "widget.(bounds_x+bounds_cx)" more than "splitter.(bounds_x+bounds_cx)"

		= spo_dockbottom
			* causes the "linkbottom" widget to dock to the bottom border of splitter
			* make sence only if linkbottom "widget.(bounds_y+bounds_cy)" more than "splitter.(bounds_y+bounds_cy)"

		!!! Two special cases :

		1. (spo_dockleft = spo_dockright = TRUE) && (linkleft = linkright = the_same_widget) : 
			causes the "linkleft" widget to adjust to h-positiion & width of the splitter, 
			it's even possible that the widget doesn't touch the splitter

			(spo_docktop = spo_dockbottom = TRUE) && (linktop = linkbottom = the_same_widget) : 
			causes the "linktop" widget to adjust to v-position & height of the splitter, 

			It's even possible in these cases that the widget doesn't touch the splitter

	- optionsscale
		= see {tscalingwidget.optionsscale}

	- optionswidget
		= see {anywidget.optionswidget}

	- onactivate, onchildscaled, ondeactivate, ondefocus, onenter, onexit, onfocus,
	  onfontheightdelta, onmove, onpopup, onresize, onshowhint
		= see "tspacer"

	- onupdatelayout
		fires :
		
		= on creating the splitter
		= on any reposition of the linked widgets 
		( due to moving the splitter, resizing the parent,.. )

TSpacer

* a regular widget which creates a kind of positional link between surrounding widgets
* designed to maintain distances between widgets
* may have GUI look, caption etc switched off by default
* resizing a spacer repositions its linked widgets

Properties:

- anchors = see {any_widget.anchors}

- bounds = see {any_widget.bounds}

- color = see {any_widget.color}

- enabled = "false" turns color of the caption to gray

- visible = "true" allows displayable settings (caption text, face, frame etc) to take effect in run-time as well

- <face> = see {any face}

- <frame> = see {any frame}

- linkbottom = widget linked down to most outer edge (incl. frame[.caption]) of the spacer - linkleft = widget linked left to most outer edge of the spacer - linkright = widget linked right to most outer edge of the spacer - linktop = widget linked up to most outer edge of the spacer

- dist_bottom, dist_left, dist_right, dist_top : = margins between most outer edge the spacer and the corresponding linked widget

- options :

= spao_glueright

- if "false"

h-repositioning or h-resizing the linkleft widget shifts the whole linked construction, it becomes the only way to h-shift

if {an_right IN linkright_widget.anchors} then the spacer may be right-resized with auto h-resizing the linkright widget so that the right margin of that widget is kept

if NOT {an_right IN linkright_widget.anchors} then the spacer may be right-resized with auto h-shifting the linkright widget so that width of that widget is kept

- if "true"

h-repositioning or h-resizing the linkright widget shifts the whole linked construction, it becomes the only way to h-shift

if {an_left IN linkleft_widget.anchors} then the spacer may be h-resized with auto h-resizing the linkleft widget so that the left margin of that widget is kept

if NOT {an_left IN linkleft_widget.anchors} then the spacer may be h-resized with auto h-shifting the linkleft widget so that width of that widget is kept

= spao_gluebottom

- if "false"

v-repositioning or v-resizing the linktop widget shifts the whole linked construction, it becomes the only way to v-shift

if {an_bottom IN linkbottom_widget.anchors} then the spacer may be v-resized with auto v-resizing the linkbottom widget so that the bottom margin of that widget is kept

if NOT {an_bottom IN linkbottom_widget.anchors} then the spacer may be v-resized with auto v-shifting the linkbottom widget so that height of that widget is kept

- if "true"

v-repositioning or v-resizing the linkbottom widget shifts the whole linked construction, it becomes the only way to v-shift

if {an_top IN linktop_widget.anchors} then the spacer may be v-resized with auto v-resizing the linktop widget so that the top margin of that widget is kept

if NOT {an_top IN linktop_widget.anchors} then the spacer may be v-resized with auto v-shifting the linktop widget so that height of that widget is kept

- optionsscale = see {tscalingwidget.optionsscale}

- optionswidget = see {anywidget.optionswidget}

- onactivate, onchildscaled, ondeactivate, ondefocus, onenter, onexit, onfocus, onfontheightdelta, onpopup, onresize, onshowhint = see {any_widget.*}

- onmove = see {any_window.OnMove}

any "link*" option set disables the spacer to reposition solely, repositioning is only controlled by a "glued" widget since then

TLayouter

  • a tspacer descendant designed to (auto)resize or/and move its contained widgets acc to some size/positon dependencies
  • may have GUI look, frame caption etc switched off by default
  • layouters may be nested to achieve complex layouts

Each layout change/assignment is divided into performing 3 consequent stages :

Stage 1

Widgets auto resized using the following options:

- if {lao_placex OR lao_placey} :

		= if {plo_scalesize in optionslayout}  then
			* widgets with "osk_nopropwith" unset in their "optionsskin" are h-scaled 
		  	  in the proportion of change of tlayouter's clientwidth
			* widgets with "osk_nopropheight" unset in their "optionsskin" are v-scaled 
		  	  in the proportion  of change of tlayouter's clientheight

			For h-resized layouter, the effect looks like :

		 	 |--Widget__1---Widget__2--|		=> the initial look

		  	 |--Widget_1--Widget_2--|			=> the layouter gets narrower

		  	 |---Widget___1---Widget___2---|	=> the layouter gets wider

			*** both widget sizes & margins are affected ***
			*** Widget_N may generally situate on different y-levels *** 
		  	
	otherwise :

		= if lao_scalewidth in optionslayout :
			* widgets with "osk_nopropwith" unset in their "optionsskin" enters in the mode 
		 	  ( not applied until the layouter resizes! ) when they are h-scaled in the proportion 
		 	  as far as clientwidth of the tlayouter changes, then stages 2 & 3 are reapplied

			For h-resized layouter, the effect looks like :

			  |--Single____widget????|		=> the initial look

			  |--Single__widget???|			=> the layouter gets narrower

			  |--Single_______widget?????|	=> the layouter gets wider

			* also, if {lao_scaleleft in optionslayout} then left margins of the widgets 
			  with unset "optionsskin.osk_nopropleft" resize too otherwise retain

		= if lao_scaleheight in optionslayout :
			* widgets with "osk_nopropheight" unset in their "optionsskin" enters in the mode 
		 	  ( not applied until the layouter resizes! ) when they are v-scaled in the proportion 
		  	  as far as clientheight of the tlayouter changes, then stages 2 & 3 are reapplied

			* also, if {lao_scaletop in optionslayout} then top margins of the widgets 
			  with unset "optionsskin.osk_noproptop" resize too otherwise retain

			*** only widget sizes & margins not distances between them are affected ***

Stage 2

Widgets may be auto resized in 5 consequent steps using the following options:


1. if plo_syncmaxautosize in place_options :
   = all widgets are autosized then their client areas are synchronised to the
     clientareas of the highest and the widest of the widget
   * calls "msegui.syncmaxautosize"

2. if plo_syncpaintwidth in place_options :
   = the paintwidths of all widgets are synchronized to the widget with the
     widest outer frame width ( ex. width of "frame.caption" )
   * mainly makes sense if "lao_alignx" set and {align_glue = wam_start or wam_end}
     ( see below ) when the widgets will be adjusted in order to fit into the
     inner client width of tlayouter:

                                   x-align level           
                                         V                 
                        +----------------------------------+
                        | Widget_1 the_widest_frame_caption|
                        | Widget_2 frame_caption2          |
                        | Widget_N wider_frame_captionN    |
                        +----------------------------------+

   here, the effect is shown for "cp_right" frame captions
     // otherwise syncronizes to the outer ( of the frame except its caption ) width 
     // of the Z-top widget
   * calls "msegui.syncpaintwidth"
   * paintwidth is the outer width

3. if plo_syncpaintheight in place_options :
   = the paintheights of all widgets are synchronized to the widget with the
     highest outer frame width ( ex. width of "frame.caption" ).
   * mainly makes sense if lao_aligny set and {align_glue = wam_start or wam_end}
     ( see below ) the widgets will be adjusted in order to fit into the inner
     client height of tlayouter :

                        +------------------------------+
                        | The_                         |
                        | tallest_            taller_  |
                        | frame_    frame_    frame_   |
                        | caption   caption2  captionN |  
                        |                              |
                        | Widget1   Widget_2  Widget_N |<== y-align level 
                        +------------------------------+     		

  here, the effect is shown for "cp_topleft" frame captions
    // otherwise syncronizes to the outer ( of the frame except its caption ) 
    // height of the Z-top widget
  * calls "msegui.syncpaintheight"
 
4. plo_synccaptiondistx in place_options :
   = causes all widgets to have the widest common room for their cp_(left/right)* frame captions
   * calls "msegui.synccaptiondistx"
 
5. plo_synccaptiondisty in place_options :
   = causes all widgets to have the highest common room for their cp_(top/bottom)* frame captions
   * calls "msegui.synccaptiondisty"

Stage 3

The widgets may be (re)arranged within the layouter.

There're 2 modes of such (re)arrangement which can be partially (orthogonally)
combined (see later):

1) The place(ment) mode ( lao_place* in optionslayout ) :

- widgets are placed at some distances between each other, possibly with some
  margins, rooms of invisible widgets ( having visible=false) are also allocated
  unless "plo_noinvisible in place_options"

  * the widgets are placed in the order of decreasing their "widgetrect.x"
	coordinates before alignment
  
  * the inter-widget distances and the side margins ( if apllied ) in both
	dimentions are identical and limited between "place_mindist" and
	"place_maxdist"
  
  = if {lao_placex in optionslayout} and {place_mode <> wam_none} then the
	following relevant settings apply:
  
	* non-limiting value of "place_maxdist" :
	
		# |Widget_1------Widget_2------Widget_3| 
	
	* non-limiting value of "place_maxdist" and {plo_propmargin in place_options} :
	
		# |---Widget_1---Widget_2---Widget_3---|
		
	* limiting value of "place_maxdist" and {place_mode = wam_start} :
	
		# |Widget_1----Widget_2----Widget_3????|
		
	* limiting value of "place_maxdist" and {place_mode = wam_start} and
	  {plo_propmargin in place_options} :
	
		# |---Widget_1---Widget_2---Widget_3???|
		
	* limiting value of "place_maxdist" and {place_mode = wam_end} :
	
		# |??????Widget_1---Widget_2---Widget_3|
		
	* limiting value of "place_maxdist" and {place_mode = wam_end} and
	  {plo_propmargin in place_options} :
	
		# |???Widget_1---Widget_2---Widget_3---|
		
	* limiting value of "place_maxdist" and {place_mode = wam_center} :
	
		# |???Widget_1---Widget_2---Widget_3???|
		
	* limiting value of "place_maxdist" and {plo_endmargin in place_options} :
	
		# |Widget_1----Widget_2----Widget_____3|, or
		
		# |Widget_1----Widget_____2----Widget_3|, or
		
		# |Widget_____1----Widget_2----Widget_3|, here, the most left amongst
		widgets having both [an_left,an_right] set is expanded otherwise the most
		right widget ( Widget_3 in the example )
		
	* limiting value of "place_maxdist" and {place_mode = wam_end} and
	  {plo_propmargin in place_options} and {plo_endmargin in place_options} :
	  
		# |--Widget_1--Widget_____2--Widget_3--|,
		  
	The Legend:
	===========
	limiting value of "place_maxdist" : such value which produce some visual
	effect on the layouter
	
	  "----" :           distance ( = number of minuses, limited by place_maxdis )
	  "????" :           some remaining space ( = number of questmarks )
	  "Widget_1" :       widget of the original size
	  "Widget__..__1" : (auto)resized widget
  
  = if {lao_placey in optionslayout} and {place_mode <> wam_none} then the things
	are handled in the same manner as with "lao_placex" but for the vertical
	"top2bottom" direction of placement instead of the horizontal "left2right" one.

2) the align(ment) mode ( optionslayout.lao_align* ) :

- widgets are gathered into a visual group to a dedicated "leader" widget of
  the layout ( set by "align_leader" and defaults to the lowest in
  Z-Order = twidget.widgets[0] ) the leader stays in place while the others :

  = if lao_alignx in optionslayout ( the hor alignment mode ):
	  * if align_mode = wam_start :
		snap their left borders to the left border of leader
	  * else if align_mode = wam_end :
		snap their right borders to the right border of leader
	  * else if align_mode = wam_center :
		snap their v-axes to the v-axis of leader after that,
  = if lao_aligny in optionslayout ( the vert alignment mode ):
	  * if align_mode = wam_start :
		snap their top borders to the top border of leader
	  * else if align_mode = wam_end :
		snap their bottom borders to the bottom border of leader
	  * else if align_mode = wam_center :
		snap their h-axes to the h-axis of leader

- after that, the whole widget group can be aligned within the layouter:

  = if align_glue =  wam_start
	  * if lao_alignx in optionslayout:
		the left extent of group snaps to the left border of layouter
	  * if lao_aligny in optionslayout:
		the top extent of group snaps to the top border of layouter
  = else if align_glue = wam_end
	  * if lao_alignx in optionslayout:
		the right extent of group snaps to the right border of layouter
	  * if lao_aligny in optionslayout:
		the bottom extent of group snaps to the bottom border of layouter
  = else if align_glue =  wam_center
	  * if lao_alignx in optionslayout:
		the v-axis of group snaps to the v-axis of layouter
	  * if lao_aligny in optionslayout:
		the h-axis of group snaps to the h-axis of layouter

Mutually exclusive settings:
* only one of "align_mode" can be choosen
* only one of  "glue_mode" can be choosen
* "optionslayout.lao_alignx" & 	"optionslayout.lao_placex"
* "optionslayout.lao_aligny" & 	"optionslayout.lao_placey"

V-alignment ( optionslayout.lao_aligny ) may be combined with h-placement
( optionslayout.lao_placex ), and h-alignment ( optionslayout.lao_alignx ) may
be combined with v-placement ( optionslayout.lao_placey )

NOTE:
  The effects of the above described { resizing / placement / alignment } are
  irreversible. So, the only way to revert is to set "wan_none" then to revert
  manually.

TListView

TImage

<any image>

	*** Note that switch to the monochrome mode is irerreversible ! ***

	alignment:

		By default, images are top-left aligned, with the original size preserved.

		al_xcentered = centers the image horizontally
		al_ycentered = centers the image vertically

		al_right = docks the image to the right border of placeholder
		al_bottom = docks the image to the bottom border of placeholder

		al_grayed = fills non-transparent areas with the selected color

		al_stretchx = adjusts size so that to fill the placeholder in width
		al_stretchy = adjusts size so that to fill the placeholder in height
		al_fit = adjusts size so that to fill the placeholder in both width & height

		al_tiled = spawns the image & tile the whole  placeholder with the copies 

		Interpolation mode while stretching

			al_intpol =	antialiases as far as the size changes 
						(the only working in Linux)
			al_or = interpolation pixel operation is "or" -> 1's are extended
			al_and = interpolation pixel operation is "and" -> 0's are extended
		( al_or and al_and only on win32, mainly useful for stretching of monochrome bitmaps) :

	colorbackground = color of image transparent ( masked ) areas in monochrome 
						non-masked mode 
	colorforeground = color of non-transparent areas in monochrome mode  

	options:

		bmo_monochrome = fills non-transparent areas with "colorforeground", 
						also, in non-masked mode, fills transparent areas 
						with "colorbackground"

		bmo_masked = activates built-in image transparency {it "hides" transparent (masked) areas}
		bmo_colormask = applies faded edge transparency on the color masked areas in the image

	transparency = makes the image transparent as long as enlights areas behind 
					the image with the selected color

	transparentcolor = for a non-masked image, assigns a color indicate transparency areas
					( on matching areas, the image will be seen through )

TDial

TChart

There are demos here:

https://github.com/mse-org/mseuniverse/tree/master/attic/msedocumenting/mse/trunk/help/tutorials/widgets/charts

TChartRecorder

TPolygon

TPickWidget

TOpenglWidget

Edit

TStringEdit

TMemoEdit

THexStringEdit

TDropdownListEdit

A tstringedit with a dropdownlist to choose text values. Important dropdown.options members:
- deo_autodropdown dropdown on keypress
- deo_selectonly don't allow entering arbitrary text.
- deo_forceselect don't allow entering empty text.

THistoryEdit

A tstringedit which shows the previously entered values in a dropdownlist for selection.

TIntegerEdit

TKeyStringEdit

Maps string to string.

TEnumEdit

Maps integer to string, zero based and sequencial (first item 0, next 1, ...).

TEnumTypeEdit

A TEnumEdit which maps Pascal enums to their names. Use OnInit event to store the typeinfo pointer of the enum type into sender.typeinfopo.

 
procedure tmainfo.enumtypeeditinit(const sender: tenumtypeedit);
begin
  sender.typeinfopo := PTypeInfo(TypeInfo(TMyEnumeratedType));
end;

TSelector

TSelector is the most specialized widget of the dropdown editwidget group, it is based on tenumedit (tenumedit maps an integer to a string) and uses for the dropdownlist a second map which must be created on the fly in ongetdropdowninfo. An example is tcommselector where the enumedit maps commnrty to commname and the dropdownlist shows the available RS232 ports only.

TRealEdit

TRealSpinEdit

TDateTimeEdit

TCalendarDateTimeEdit

TEdit

MSEgui counterpart of Delphi TEdit. You will never use it.

TWidgetGrid

TItemEdit

TDropDownItemEdit

A tstringedit with a dropdownlist to choose text values. Important dropdown.options members:
- deo_autodropdown dropdown on keypress
- deo_selectonly don't allow entering arbitrary text.
- deo_forceselect don't allow entering empty text.

TMBDropDownItemEdit

TTreeItemEdit

TRecordFieldEdit

Used in twidgetgrid in order to edit fields of a ttreeitemedit. Example is MSEide projecttreeform.pas.

TDialogStringEdit

A tstringedit with an ellipse button. Use "onexecute" to show the dialog.

TPointerEdit

TSlider

TProgressBar

TBooleanEdit

TBooleanEditRadio

TDataButton

A button with an integer value. Clicking increments the value until "max", then it restarts with "min". Can be inserted into a twidgetgrid. The current value selects the showed image and face by the items of "imagenums" and "valuefaces".

TStockGlyphDataButton

TDataIcon

Shows an imagelist item by lookup from "value" to "imagenums". Clicking increments value until "max" then it restarts with "min". Can be inserted into a twidgetgrid.

TTextEdit

Only useful if inserted into a twidgetgrid, builds a text editor, used in MSEide source editor.

TDataImage

A pixmap display widget which can be inserted into twidgetgrid.

TTerminal

Only useful if inserted into a twidgetgrid, builds a very simple terminal emulator. Used in MSEide target console.

NoGui

TAction

	Shortcut processing order :

	- the smallest piece of processing is "doshortcut" procedure which 
	is called until processed:
		= starting from the sender up to the toplevel widget
		= then by all child widgets with non-set "ow_noparentshortcut" 
		= then, if "ow_nochildshortcut" isn't set, by the parent widget
		= then by the widget oneself
	
	- "doshortcut" is checked in the following order:
		= starting from form's main menu
		= then from the owning window ( the widget oneself ) 
		= then from the application


		*** A shortcut is bound to a widget by :
			- placing an action component on the widget ***
			- direct assigning the shortcut to the widget (menus,..) 
	---------------------------

		caption, color, colorglyph, helpcontext, hint, imagecheckedoffset,
		imagelist <see "timagelist">, imagenr, imagenrdisabled

			- sets look of "clients" (buttons, menu/toolbar items,..), unless 
			these clients have "state.as_local*" set :

		*** For meaning of these options, see help on the "client" widgets ***

	group
		- default value for one-named property of the bound widgets
		( menu items,... )

	options :
		ao_updateonidle
			- runs this action in cycle, waiting for no gui events everytime

		ao_globalshortcut 
			- allows the action to trigger on a non-main form
			  (the shortcut is triggered whatever form of the applicatin it was pressed on, 
			  otherwise only when the form where the aption is placed on is focused )

		ao_nocandefocus 
			- causes the action not to call "CanDefocus" for focused edit widget of active form
			  before executing own code
			  ( it helps to avoid the effect of cancelling changes in these widgets 
			  on activating the bound shortcut )

	shortcut
		- keyboard combination triggering the action

	shortcut
		- alternative "shortcut" and handled identically

	state :

		as_disabled
			- prevents the action from triggering, also puts the bound widgets to "disabled" look

		as_invisible
			- in run-time, hides the bound widget, still reacting on the shortcut or direct call

		as_checked
			- selects the bound menu item if it has "mao_checkbox" option set

		as_default
		as_local*

	statfile	
		<see "tstatfile">

	stavarname

	
	tagaction
	onasyncevent
	onchange
	onexecute
	onupdate

TActivator

TCustomLookupbuffer

	-	provides a group of parallel arrays of float(=datetime), integer and widestring types,
		and facilities to :
			= search in any array
			= on found position, quickly obtain corresponding value in another array
	-	for each type, several arrays  may be kept
	- 	each array is integer-indexed, even string ones ( case[in]sensitive )
	-	uses two way of accessing arrays data, through :
			= physic : array storage index ( row number ) directly
			= logical : the integer index ( see above ):
				first, physic row number is known for the logical index then the data 
				are accessed with the found number

			*** logical index values are built automatically based on array values, 
			on updating its data ***
	- dont' have interface to load data ( see its descendants for that )
	
	fieldcountfloat - number of float arrays
	fieldcountinteger - number of integer arrays
	fieldcounttext - number of widestring arrays

	Event handlers:
		- onchange

	Public interface:

   		procedure beginupdate; - marks beginning of "update"
   		procedure endupdate; - if all "update" finished, fires "onchange" event
	 	procedure clearbuffer; - clears all arrays then fires "onchange"

   		procedure checkbuffer; 
   			- [re]loads the arrays with most actual data
   			- just a stub here since doesn't have a data source

   		function find(const fieldno: integer; const avalue: integer/realty/msestring;
         	out aindex: integer; const filter: lbfiltereventty = nil): boolean;
			- applies external filtering ("filter" procedure) then incrementally searches integer/realty(datetime) array "fieldno" 
			for value "avalue" starting from logical index "aindex", returns "true" and the updated logical index 
			if found else next bigger; 

   		function find(const fieldno: integer; const avalue: msestring;
                 out aindex: integer;
                 const caseinsensitive: boolean;
                 const filter: lbfiltereventty = nil): boolean; overload;
			- applies external filtering ("filter" procedure) then incrementally searches widestring array "fieldno" for value "avalue", 
			in "caseinsensitive" manner, starting from logical index "aindex", returns "true" and the updated logical index 
			if found else next bigger;

   		function findphys(const fieldno: integer; const avalue: integer;
         	out aindex: integer; const filter: lbfiltereventty = nil): boolean; overload;
			- applies external filtering ("filter" procedure) then incrementally searches integer/realty(datetime) array "fieldno" 
			for value "avalue" starting from row number "aindex", returns "true" and the updated row number 
			if found else next bigger; 

		function findphys(const fieldno: integer; const avalue: msestring;  out aindex: integer; const caseinsensitive: boolean;
                 const filter: lbfiltereventty = nil): boolean; overload;
			- applies external filtering ("filter" procedure) then incrementally searches widestring array "fieldno" for value "avalue", 
			in "caseinsensitive" manner, starting from row number "aindex", returns "true" and the updated row number  
			if found else next bigger;

			The external filtering ("filter") procedure takes the arguments of the caller 
			togehther with physical row number found in the caller which allows 
			to check several values at once for that number, within the filter
			
		function integervaluephys(const fieldno,aindex: integer): integer;
			-  returns value of integer array "fieldno" at row number "aindex" 
              
		function integervaluelog(const fieldno,aindex: integer): integer;
			-  returns value of integer array "fieldno" where the array index equals to "aindex" 

		function integerindex(const fieldno,aindex: integer): integer;
			- returns row number of integer array "fieldno" where the array index equals to "aindex"

		function integerindexar(const fieldno: integer): integerarty;
			- returns all bunch of indexes of integer array "fiedlno"

		function integerar(const fieldno: integer): integerarty;
			- returns all bunch of data of integer array "fiedlno"
   
		function floatvaluephys(const fieldno,aindex: integer): realty;
			-  returns value of real/datetime array "fieldno" at row number "aindex" 

		function floatvaluelog(const fieldno,aindex: integer): realty;
			-  returns value of real/datetime array "fieldno" where the array index equals to "aindex" 

		function floatindex(const fieldno,aindex: integer): integer;
			- returns row number of real/datetime array "fieldno" where the array index equals to "aindex"

		function floatindexar(const fieldno: integer): integerarty;
			- returns all bunch of indexes of real/datetime array "fiedlno"

		function floatar(const fieldno: integer): realarty;
			- returns all bunch of data of real/datetime array "fiedlno"   

		function textvaluephys(const fieldno,aindex: integer): msestring;
			-  returns value of widestring array "fieldno" at row number "aindex" 

		function textvaluelog(const fieldno,aindex: integer;
                       const caseinsensitive: boolean): msestring;
			-  returns value of widestring array "fieldno" where the array index equals to "aindex" 

		function textindex(const fieldno,aindex: integer;
                      const caseinsensitive: boolean): integer;
			- returns row number of widestring array "fieldno" where the array index equals to "aindex"

		function textindexar(const fieldno: integer;
                            const caseinsensitive: boolean): integerarty;
			- returns all bunch of indexes of widestring array "fiedlno"

		function textar(const fieldno: integer): msestringarty;
			- returns all bunch of data of widestring array "fiedlno"   

   
		function lookupinteger(const integerkeyfieldno,integerfieldno,
                                keyvalue: integer): integer; overload;
			- returns value of integer array "integerfieldno" at position where
				value of parallel integer array "integerkeyfieldno" equals to "keyvalue"
                ( 0 if not found )

		function lookupinteger(const stringkeyfieldno,integerfieldno: integer;
                         const keyvalue: msestring): integer; overload;
			- returns value of integer array "integerfieldno" at position where
				value of parallel widestring array "stringkeyfieldno" equals to "keyvalue"
                ( 0 if not found )

		function lookuptext(const integerkeyfieldno,textfieldno,
                                keyvalue: integer): msestring; overload;
			- returns value of integer array "textfieldno" at position where
				value of parallel integer array "integerkeyfieldno" equals to "keyvalue"
                ( '' if not found )

		function lookuptext(const stringkeyfieldno,textfieldno: integer;
                      const keyvalue: msestring): msestring; overload;
			- returns value of integer array "textfieldno" at position where
				value of parallel integer array "integerkeyfieldno" equals to "keyvalue"
                ( '' if not found )


		function lookupfloat(const integerkeyfieldno,floatfieldno,
                                keyvalue: integer): realty; overload;
			- returns value of real/datetime array "floatfieldno" at position where
				value of parallel integer array "integerkeyfieldno" equals to "keyvalue"
                ( emptyreal if not found )

		function lookupfloat(const stringkeyfieldno,floatfieldno: integer;
                                keyvalue: msestring): realty; overload;

			- returns value of real/datetime array "floatfieldno" at position where
				value of parallel widestring array "stringkeyfieldno" equals to "keyvalue"
                ( emptyreal if not found )

		function count: integer; - returns number of data rows

		property fieldcounttext: integer; -  returns/sets number of widestring arrays
		property fieldcountfloat: integer; - returns/sets number of real/datetime arrays
		property fieldcountinteger: integer; - returns/sets number of integer arrays

		 the above "fieldcount*" props clear the buffer on setting a value 

		property integervalue[const fieldno,aindex: integer]: integer; - a shortcut to "integervaluephys"
		property floatvalue[const fieldno,aindex: integer]: realty; - a shortcut to "floatvaluephys"
		property textvalue[const fieldno,aindex: integer]: msestring; - a shortcut to "textvaluephys"

		property onchange: notifyeventty; 
			- called in "changed" wich in turn is called in :
				= clearbuffer
				= endupdate
				= doasyncevent
				= loaded
				= tlookupbuffer.addrow

TLookupBuffer

tlookupbuffer = class(tcustomlookupbuffer)

	- extends "tcustomlookupbuffer" with methods of run-time data filling

	- see <tcustomlookupbuffer>

	+= Extentions to the public interface:

		procedure addrow(const integervalues: array of integer;
                    const textvalues: array of msestring;
                    const floatvalues: array of realty);

			- adds one row to each of widestring arrays, integer arrays and real/datetime arrays,
			array size of  "{type}values" equals to number of {type} arrays

   		procedure addrows(const integervalues: array of integerarty;
                    const textvalues: array of msestringarty;
                    const floatvalues: array of realarty);

			- adds many data rows  to each of widestring arrays, integer arrays and real/datetime arrays, 
			only min length of the input data arrays are inserted, longer data are truncated
			array size of  "{type}values" equals to number of {type} arrays and the size of "{type}values[i]"
			describes number od data elements in the array
		

TDBLookupBuffer

tdblookupbuffer = class(tcustomdblookupbuffer -> tcustomlookupbuffer)

	- extends "tcustomlookupbuffer" with interface to fill arrays with DB-data
	- see <tcustomlookupbuffer> & <tcustomdblookupbuffer>

	 Extentions to the public interface:

   		procedure checkbuffer; - if data obsolete ("invalid") then reloads them from "datasource"
   
		property datasource: tdatasource; - sets/returns DB data source where to load data from
		property textfields: tdbfieldnamearrayprop; - allows to assign a {datasource:datafield} to each of widestring arrays
		property integerfields: tdbfieldnamearrayprop; - allows to assign a {datasource:datafield} to each of integer arrays
		property floatfields: tdbfieldnamearrayprop; - allows to assign a {datasource:datafield} to each of real/datetime arrays

		property optionsdb: lbdboptionsty; - tunes some DB behaviour apects
			-	olbdb_closedataset : 
				= once data obsolete, opens (if needed) the supplier dataset (disabling its bound controls) 
				then [re]loads data from it then closes it

			-	olbdb_invalidateifmodified :
				= gets marked "invalid" once contents of the bound dataset change, 
				it signals to reload the buffer with the new data just before next accessing 
				( for any purpose - searching, lookuping, getting value/(array of values),..)

TDBmemoLookupbuffer

- allows to use  for lookup-ing any text-convertable DB-fields
	- an analog of tdblookupbuffer, but :
		- "integerfields" may be names of any integer-convertable DB-fields
		- "floatfields" may be names of any (real/datetime)-convertable DB-fields
		- "textfields"  may be names of any text-presentable DB-fields

		- each DB-field value ( presenting a memo generally of many lines ) may supply many data rows at once 
		to the bound array of the buffer, since this value will be internally splitted & turned into native array values,
		and the resulting "count" (arrays row count) of the whole buffer will be the minimal rows count amongst arrays 
		of the buffer, the rest data are truncated 

		- when loading widestring arrays, also checks for & performs "utf8-to-widestring" conversion of values of 
		the bound DB-fields so that these arrays always store widestrings

TThreadComp

TStatFile

- so that to be in effect, it should also be assigned to the form where the widget using the stafile is placed on
- in design, if "onstatwrite" is set and "filedir" is not yet created,	deactivate exception "ECreateError" in project settings ( "Debugger" tab )
- "filedir" may contain "~/" indicating the user's home directory
- options "oe_savestate" & "oe_savevalue" of "client" widgets define what to store to the file 
- position etc changes or/and value changes 
- in case when a main form shares its stafile with non-main forms, on creating non-main ones, just edited not saved data of the main form ( bound to vars of the statfile) are reset to values read from the statfile upon creating the form; for "sfo_memory", this effect absents unless widgets on the concurring forms share same variable[s]; to avoid this behaviour, disable "fo_autoreadstat" & "fo_autowritestat" of the non-main forms
- each "tstafile" owns:
 = tstatwriter:
* provides methods of writing sections & statvars to a memory/file stream
- tstatreader:
* holds list of sections with statvars each
* provides search & check & reading interface to the statvars
* provides reading statvars from a memory/file stream

Positioning to a section speeds up accessing its statvars

- there also is "tstatfiler" ( exposed by some "tstatfile" events ) which:
= may present or "tstatwriter" or "tstatreader" ( there's a check method )
= provides directionless "update" methods with internal switch to needed direction of processing 
- "reading" or "writing" statvars on per-section basis


	activator :
		<see tactivator> : NOT YET DONE		

	encoding = "en_utf8" selected here, allows to store non-Latin text in the file
       filedir = directory where to keep the file ( by default - the current working directory )
	filename = name of the file

	options:
		sfo_memory = reads & writes not from a disk file but from a named memory stream 
					( there's an exclusion - see below "sfo_savedata" ),
					mostly useful for presenting last used values on recalling 
					non-main forms etc ( data even survive recreating forms),
					or even for data "exchange" between non-main modal( non-concurring ) forms 
					in case of the target widgets share same statvarnames

		sfo_createpath = creates "filedir" if necessary
		sfo_savedata =	used only with "sfo_memory", commands to save 
						the memory data to the master statfile (see below)						

	sfo_activatorread = activator activate triggers reading ???
	sfo_activatorwrite = activator deactivate triggers writing ???

	statfile = a master statfile
	statvarname = name of section of this file in the upper statfile
	Tag = an integer property for misc purposes

	Event handlers:
		onstatafterread - fires on return from "readstat"
		onstatafterwrite - fires on return from "writestat"
		onstatbeforeread - fires on beginning of "readstat"
		onstatbeforewrite - fires on beginning of "writestat"
		onstatread = fires after reading state data
		onstatwrite = fires after writing state data
		onstatupdate = fires after reading/writing state data just before 
					"onstatread" & "onstatwrite"

	Public methods:

   		procedure initnewcomponent(const ascale: real); override;
   			- does nothing but fixes the default file name as the statfile default
   
   		procedure readstat(stream: ttextstream = nil); overload;
   			- rereads all statvars of the stafile/memorystream
   
   		procedure readstat(const aname: msestring; const statreader: tstatreader); overload;
   			- rereads "aname" statvar of the statfile

   		procedure writestat(const stream: ttextstream = nil); overload;
		   	- rewrites all statvars to the stafile/memorystream
			  (if neccessary, prepares to writting - creates "filedir", stafile,...)
   
   		procedure writestat(const aname: msestring; const statwriter: tstatwriter); overload;
   			- overwrites "aname" statvar of the statfile
   		
   		procedure updatestat(const aname: msestring; const statfiler: tstatfiler);
   			- depending on kind of "statfiler" ( writer/reader ), writes/reads 
   			  the most up-to-date stat data

TTimer

TNoGuiAction

TPipeReadercomp

TSysEnvManager

TProcessMonitor

TFilechangeNotifier

TShortCutController

TPostscriptPrinter

TGdiPrinter

TWmfPrinter

TSkinController

TGuiThreadComp

Font

See also : Reference:_MSEgui/TFont

Any Font

    	charset { ANSI/ DEFAULT/ SYMBOL /SHIFTJIS /HANGEUL /GB2312 /CHINESEBIG5 /OEM 
		/JOHAB / HEBREW/ ARABIC/ GREEK/ TURKISH/ VIETNAMESE/ THAI/ EASTEUROPE/
		RUSSIAN/ MAC/ BALTIC }
		- changes the font to the nearest containing the selected encoding(charset)
		- no font change made if the supplied encoding doesn't match any font
	color
		- color of the glyphs contours
	colorbackground
		- fill color of the glyph cells ( not including extraspace )
	colorshadow
		- color of SE glyph "edges" ( if not "cl_none", deactivates "colorbackground" )
	extraspace
		- v-space between glyph cells of adjacent text rows (negative values cause the cells to overlap )
	height
		- v-size of glyph cells, in pixels
	name
		- initially, font is choosen by { "family" = this name }
	options:
		foo_fixed
			- changes the font to the nearest "mono" spaced (usually = Courier)
		foo_proportional
			- changes the font to the nearest "proportionally" spaced (usually = Helvetica)
		foo_helvetica
			- changes the font to the nearest in "sans" category (usually = Helvetica)
		foo_roman
			- changes the font to the nearest in "serif" category (usually = Times[ New Roman])
		foo_script
			- Win32 only, changes the font to the nearest in "script" category
		foo_decorative
			- Win32 only, changes the font to the nearest in "decorative" category
		foo_antialiased
			- Linux-only, enables antialiasing (if disabled by Xft globally)
		foo_nonantialiased
			- Linux-only, disables antialiasing (if enabled by Xft globally) 
			usually making glyph extents (not cells !) a bit wider
	style:
		fs_bold
			- gives the font a "bold" look
		fs_italic
			- gives the font an "italic" look
		fs_underline
			- gives the font an "underlined" look
		fs_strikeout
			- gives the font a "striked out" look
		fs_selected
			- "TRUE" here combined with {tf_noselect:=FALSE}, causes the text described by this font 
			to be initially selected ( with the clipboard operations available ), 
			currently applicable only to richstrings

	width
		- 10*{ glyph cell width, average in pixels }, 0 = {font default}

	xscale
		- width ratio of each glyph {cell & contour}, the effect is similar to "width"

		*** "foo_*" font selection overrides one made with "name" 

		*** if change with "foo_*" is unsuccessful then the nearest "sans" font is usually chosen

		*** The categories :

			sans		=> have no serifs and have strokes of even thickness
			serif		=> have serifs at glyph contours and made up of strokes of varying thickness
			script		=> resemble handwriting
			decorative	=> flashy styles to be used sparingly in headlines or posters

GUI

TWindow

twindow = class(teventobject,icanvas)
  public

	// releases mouse, unlinks from the canvas, processes all pending events of the window
	// if called from within main thread then destroys the window directly
	// otherwise posts a window destroy event for oneself and waits for it to be processed
	procedure destroywindow;

	// registers the instance of onself in the "owner" widget, allocates the canvas, 
	// adds a reference to oneself,
	// then prepares the "owner" hierarchy to be invalidated ( "owner.rootchanged" )
	// since now, the window is allocated and belongs to the "aowner" widget 
	constructor create(aowner: twidget);

	destructor destroy; override;

	// adds "method" to the internal list of scroll dependants
	procedure registeronscroll(const method: notifyeventty);

	// removes "method" from the internal list of scroll dependants
	procedure unregisteronscroll(const method: notifyeventty);

	// releases mouse if captured, resets the cursor, then enters an event loop for the window,
	// TRUE on return if the window is destroyed
	function beginmodal: boolean;
 
	  * checks if the "sender" window is already modal to avoid circularity, 
	    if not then starts an event loop  for the "sender" where the "sender" is a receiver of GUI events,
   	    once the loop is terminated reactivates the previously active window if it was,
	    TRUE if modalwindow destroyed  

	  function tinternalapplication.beginmodal(const sender: twindow): boolean;

	// removes the internal stuff which indicates the modal state
	procedure endmodal;

	// if the window is visible, 
	// deactivates the previously active window, shows the window (see below),
	// if no active window in the app or the window or its Z-predecessor is modal and 
	// the app has no focused widget then prepares the bound widget to be focused,
	// then addresses the WM to put the window to foreground
	procedure activate;

	  // if the bound widget has visible=true then:
	  //  - if NOT windowevent then :
	  //    = address the WM to set size of the window acc to window opts 
	  //      wp_maximized, wp_fullscreen or normal size otherwise
	  //	= if the window is normally sized, moves it to its default position is specified ( screen centered etc )
	  // - unhides/unminimizes the window if needed
	  // - shows other windows of the applications acc to state of the window group 
	  // ( in normal size or minimized )

	  private 
		procedure twindow.show(windowevent: boolean);

	// TRUE if this window currently grabs user input
	( a widget drawn within the window(=form) is in focus,.. )
	function active: boolean;

	// if the window was active then deactivates the window  & remembers it as the previous active ( to restore leater if requested ),
	// returns TRUE if that storage occurred
	function deactivateintermediate: boolean; 

	// makes the window active & clears the above app reference to it ( "active before deactivating" )
	procedure reactivate; //clears app.finactivewindow

	// scans the app event queue for "ek_expose" event[s] addressed to the window,
	// if found then redraws that part of the window which the event describes
	// ( processed events are then deleted )
	procedure update;

	// TRUE if the window :
	// 1) doesn't have an inner widget grabbing input focus
	// or
	// 2) has such widget, and this widget ( and all its descendants ) 
	//    pass "CanClose" check
	//
	// *** see also "twidget.CanClose" ***
	//
	function candefocus: boolean;

	// tries to defocus the currently focused widget if it belongs to the window,
	// if succeeds then executes code of virtual "DoDefocus" of the widget descessor
	// ( this code defines behaviour & look of the widget on defocusing );
	//
	// no defocusing is done if the focused widget ( or its descendants ) 
	// doesn't pass "CanClose" check
	//
	procedure nofocus;
   
   	// setfocusedwidget(widget)
   
   property focuscount: cardinal read ffocuscount;
   function close: boolean; //true if ok
   procedure beginmoving; //lock window rect modification
   procedure endmoving;
   procedure bringtofront;
   procedure sendtoback;
   procedure stackunder(const predecessor: twindow);
       //stacking is performed in mainloop idle, nil means top
   procedure stackover(const predecessor: twindow);
       //stacking is performed in mainloop idle, nil means bottom
   function stackedunder: twindow; //nil if top
   function stackedover: twindow;  //nil if bottom
   function hastransientfor: boolean;

   procedure capturemouse;
   procedure releasemouse;
   procedure postkeyevent(const akey: keyty; 
        const ashiftstate: shiftstatesty = []; const release: boolean = false;
                  const achars: msestring = '');

   function winid: winidty;
   function haswinid: boolean;
   function state: windowstatesty;
   function visible: boolean;
   function activating: boolean; //in internalactivate proc
   function normalwindowrect: rectty;
   property updateregion: regionty read fupdateregion;
   function updaterect: rectty;

   procedure registermovenotification(sender: iobjectlink);
   procedure unregistermovenotification(sender: iobjectlink);

   property options: windowoptionsty read foptions;

	// widget 
	property owner: twidget read fowner;

   property focusedwidget: twidget read ffocusedwidget;
   property transientfor: twindow read ftransientfor;
   property modalresult: modalresultty read fmodalresult write setmodalresult;
   property buttonendmodal: boolean read getbuttonendmodal write setbuttonendmodal;
   property globalshortcuts: boolean read getglobalshortcuts write setglobalshortcuts;
   property localshortcuts: boolean read getlocalshortcuts write setlocalshortcuts;
   property windowpos: windowposty read getwindowpos write setwindowpos;
   property caption: msestring read fcaption write setcaption;


 windowoptionty = (wo_popup,wo_message,wo_buttonendmodal,wo_groupleader,
                   wo_windowcentermessage); //showmessage centered in window


	optionswindow:
		wo_popup 
			- in run-time, hides all OS windows-manager ( WM ) decorations (title bar, buttons "Close/Resize,Min/Max" etc),
			letting only its client area to appear
			so :
				= the window should have own facilities to replace the deactivated WM functionality if needed
				= can't be resized/maximize/minimized/moved
		wo_message
			- similar to "wo_popup" but allows WM to close ( with "Close" button ) & move the window

		wo_groupleader
			- keeps on the WM taskbar a shortcut to the window 
			( if the parent window is a groupleader too then displays a step upper in its group )

	Event handlers:

	 - onmove
		= fires once the (window/widget) is created/moved ( with check if really moved by a distance)

TFormScrollbox

- presents client area of form & parent of its widgets, 
	initially stretched to fit the form & bound with anchoring 
	but may be adjusted with "bounds" & "anchors"
   
    Properties:
                
	anchors
	bounds
	
	color
		- color of the whole container area ( except its frame ) & form widgets 
		if their color is "cl_parent"

	name = container

	cursor,	enabled, face, frame, helpcontext, hint, optionswidget, popupmenu,
	taborder, tag, visible, onactivate, onafterpaint, onbeforepaint, 
	onchildmouseevent, onclientmouseevent, ondeativate, ondefocus, onenter,
	onexit, onfocus, onfontheightdelta, onmouseevent, onpaint, onpopup
	onresize, onshowhint
		- the same meaning as for the served form


	oncalcminscrollsize	
	onscroll
	onchildscaled	

TFaceList

TFrameComp

See also here: Reference:_MSEgui/TFrame.


	Terminology :

	{client area = area of the widget which interacts with a user}

	{bevelling = additional facets rising/sinking frame & client area, 
		constists of two parts - 
			- external: between frame and widget
			- internal: between frame and client area
	}

	{frame=	flat space between external & internal facets,
			floats at the inner level of the external facet
 	}

	*** Both frame & bevelling affect the client area ***

	--------------------------
	template:

		colorclient	=	color of the client area

		colorframe =	color of the frame
		colorframeactive =	used instead of colorframe if the widget is
							active; "cl_default" means same as colorframe.

		works if (leveli/levelo <> 0 that's the facets exist :

			colorshadow = color of facets screened from the NW light source
			colordkshadow =	color of shadows dropped by the NW light source
        	        colordkwidth =	width of the shadows in pixel, -1=default

			colorlight = color of facets exposed to the NW light source
			colorhighlight = color of brighter edges of the facets
                 	colorhlwidth = width of the brighter edges in pixel, -1=default

		        extraspace = if applied to menu items, adds more space between these items

		framei_:
			(for extendable widgets like menus, these settings widen the widget,
			for non-extendable like buttons - they squeeze the text area )

			bottom=	lower margin of text to the client area
			left =	left margin of text to the client area
			right =	margin of text to the client area
			top =	upper margin of text to the client area

		framewidth=	width of the frame
	leveli = {width=height} of the internal facet, positive -> raised, negative -> sunken
	levelo = {width=height} of the external facet, positive -> raised, negative -> sunken

<any frame>

	*** extends & customizes "tframecomp" ***

	template
		- "tframecomp" supplying the initial settings

	colorclient,colordkshadow,colordkwidth,colorframe,colorframeactive,
	colorhighlight,colorhlwidth,colorlight,colorshadow,framewidth, 
	leveli, levelo, framei_*,

		<see "tframecomp">

	font
		<see "tfont">

	caption	
		- some descriptive text( function name, user prompt,...) placed 
		in a N/W/S/E-combination to the widget's client area

		*** 
		non-empty caption if (captionpos <> cp_center) & (captiondistouter=false & captiondist>0) enlarges the framed widget 
		by the corresponding size of caption

		***

	captiondist - margin between the caption & the client area

	captiondistouter :

	- if "false"(by default), the distance is measured between 
		the inner (facing the client area) extent of the caption 
		and the client area outward the area, 
		the caption is placed outside of the client area

	- if "true", the caption is mirrored against the edge of client area as 
		to the position when "false"

		*** nagative values of "captiondist" visually inverse "out of" and within ***

       captionnoclip - do not clip frame and client area for caption background 
					( the client area preserves own background under the caption text)

	captionnooffset - shift orthogonal to "captiondist"

	captionpos - "corner" where to place the caption

	localprops :

		frl_levelo - "levelo" overrides "template.levelo"
		frl_leveli - "leveli" overrides "template.leveli"
		frl_framewidth - "framewidth" overrides "template.framewidth"
		frl_colorclient - "colorclient" overrides "template.colorclient"
		frl_colorframe - "colorframe" overrides "template.colorframe"
		frl_colorframeactive - "colorframeactive" overrides "template.colorframeactive"
		frl_colordkshadow - "colordkshadow" overrides "template.colordkshadow"
		frl_colorshadow - "colorshadow" overrides "template.colorshadow"
		frl_colorlight - "colorlight" overrides "template.colorlight"
		frl_colorhighlight - "colorhighlight" overrides "template.colorhighlight"
		frl_colordkwidth - "colordkwidth" overrides "template.colordkwidth"
		frl_colorhlwidth - "colorhlwidth" overrides "template.colorhlwidth"
		frl_fileft - "framei_left" overrides "template.framei_left"
		frl_firight - "framei_right" overrides "template.framei_right"
		frl_fitop - "framei_top" overrides "template.framei_top"
		frl_fibottom - "framei_bottom" overrides "template.framei_bottom"

		frl_nodisable

TFaceComp

See also here: https://wiki.freepascal.org/Reference:_MSEgui/TFace

	- doesn't affect the widget frame but client area of the frame


	template:
		fade:
			color[i]: = colors forming the fade
			direction: = direction where the fade grows to
			gd_(right/up/left/down)

		pos[i]: = relational position of color[i] on the direction (0.0..1.0) extent

			transparency = 	makes the face half-transparent and enlighten the underlying widget  
							with a light source of the selected color 
							( in this case, colors of the face & the widget & the light source 
							simply summarize to higher brightness )

		image:
			see <any image>

		options:

        	*** The fade colors are used not as colors but RGB alpha values ($00 -> opaque, $ff -> transparent) 
			if fao_alpha* are set *** :

				fao_alphafadeall = applies blending to the widget & all its children
				fao_alphafadenochildren = preserves child widgets from blending
		                fao_alphafadeimage = applies blending to "face.image" 


<any face>

	*** extends & customizes "tfacecomp" ***

	fade, image, option
		- see "tfacecomp"
	
	template
		- "tfacecomp" supplying the initial settings

	localprops :
		fal_options - "options" overrides "template.options"
		fal_fadirection - "fade.direction" overrides "template.fade.direction"
		fal_image - "image" overrides "template.image"
		fal_fapos - "fade.pos[i]" overrides "template.fade.pos[i]"
		fal_facolor - "fade.color[i]" overrides "template.fade.color[i]"
		fal_fatransparency - "fade.transparency" overrides "template.fade.transparency"

TBitmapComp

TScalingwidget

   optionsscale : 
		autosizing to provide room for :
		= {"frame.caption" + "offset_*"}
		= "offset_*" if "frame.caption" is unset and "osc_shrink*" is set
	
		= osc_expandx 
			- makes the widget wider to fit the caption if needed

		= osc_shrinkx
			- makes the widget narrower to have no space left & right to the "frame.caption"

		= osc_expandy
			- makes the widget taller to fit the caption if needed

		= osc_shrinky
			- makes the widget lower to have no space up & down to the "frame.caption"

		= osc_invisishrinkx
			- fully h-collapses if "visible=false" ( run-time only )

		= osc_invisishrinky
			- fully v-collapses if "visible=false" ( run-time only )

TImageList

TPopupMenu

TMainMenu

Dialog

TFileListview

TFileDialog

TFaceComp

TFileNameEdit

TDirDropdownEdit

TColorEdit

TMemoDialogEdit

TPageSizeSelector

TPageOrientationSelector

Application

TGuiApplication

 tguiapplication = class(tcustomapplication)
  public

   // [re]starts the system timer with the new period and 
   // subscribes the application to be a receiver of the modified "ek_timer" event 
   // ( can check for it in the event queue )
   procedure settimer(const us: integer);

   // finds a window by its winID
   function findwindow(id: winidty; out window: twindow): boolean;

   // finds a window by its ID & adjusts "rect" so that it 
   // fits "bounds_minc*" & "bounds_maxc*" of the found window
   procedure checkwindowrect(winid: winidty; var rect: rectty);

   // initialises the timer and "megraphics"
   procedure initialize;

   // frees the allocated system resources (GDI, event subscription, the timer)
   procedure deinitialize;

   // creates a form instance, it will be shown in "application.run"
   procedure createform(instanceclass: widgetclassty; var reference);

   // invalidates all registered forms ( all their widgets will be redrawn )
   procedure invalidate; 
   
   // calls a nested main event loop, forces processing any pending messages,
   procedure processmessages; override; //handle with care!

   // TRUE if no pending events to process for the application
   function idle: boolean; override;
   
   // requests to indicate waiting ( to show the "watches" cursors )
   procedure beginwait; override;

   // removes the "watches" if no unclosed requests for displaying them,
   // otherwise closes the currently active request
   procedure endwait; override;

   // TRUE if there are unclosed requests for displaying "watches"
   function waiting: boolean;

   // TRUE if ESC has just been pressed
   //  - if all requests for displaying "watches" are closed then refreshes 
   //    the internal list of events ( the GUI-queue -> the app event list)
   function waitescaped: boolean; //true if escape pressed while waiting

   // sets state of the current wait dialogue ( but doesn't close one ) to undefined
   procedure resetwaitdialog;   

   // runs "aexecuteaction" in the main thread in OnIdle mode,
   // then shows a cancellable message,
   // if the one is cancelled then runs "acancelaction" then 
   // either fully clears (if exceptions occur ) 
   // or terminates the execution otherwise,
   // true if not cancelled;
   // "application.processmessages" must be called regularly if "aexecuteaction" is used here,
   // alternatively "aidleaction" can be used, call sleep ( some time ) in order to minimize
   // processor load. 
   // If athread <> nil the function starts and terminates the thread    
   function waitdialog(const athread: tthreadcomp = nil; const atext: msestring = '';
                   const caption: msestring = '';
                   const acancelaction: notifyeventty = nil;
                   const aexecuteaction: notifyeventty = nil): boolean; override;

   // closes the currently modal waitdialogue with "cancelled" state
   procedure cancelwait;

   // closes the currently modal waitdialogue with "ok" state
   procedure terminatewait;

   function waitstarted: boolean;   // the last waitdialogue is currently showing for some requests
   function waitcanceled: boolean;  // the last waitdialogue has been cancelled for some request (but can be shown fot others ?)
   function waitterminated: boolean; // the last waitdialogue has been terminated for some request (but can be shown fot others ?) 

   // if called from the main app thread then shows as a modal message describing the exception 
   // otherwise posts an async event for which the message will be called
   procedure showexception(e: exception; const leadingtext: string = ''); override;

   // posts an async event for which the message describing the exception will be called
   procedure showasyncexception(e: exception; const leadingtext: string = '');

   // "application.errormessage" shows standard error message ( with "ERROR" title ) 
   procedure errormessage(const amessage: msestring); override;

   // [re]calculates timings & position of hint for "ahintedwidget"
   // if "ow_timedhint" in "ahintedwidget.foptionswidget" then iys showtime will be 
   // "defaulthintshowtime" ( an app wide setting, 3sec by default)   
   procedure inithintinfo(var info: hintinfoty; const ahintedwidget: twidget);


   // shows the supplied hint text within "aposrect" with alignment "aplacement" during "ashowtime",
   // the avail ( but not used currenly ) flags are : hfl_show,hfl_custom,hfl_noautohidemove,hfl_noautohidemove   
   procedure showhint(const sender: twidget; const hint: msestring;
              const aposrect: rectty; const aplacement: captionposty = cp_bottomleft;
              const ashowtime: integer = defaulthintshowtime; //0 -> inifinite,
                 // -1 defaultshowtime if ow_timedhint in sender.optionswidget
              const aflags: hintflagsty = defaulthintflags
                      ); overload;

   // shows the supplied hint text at left-top position"apos" during "ashowtime",
   // the avail ( but not used currenly ) flags are : hfl_show,hfl_custom,hfl_noautohidemove,hfl_noautohidemove   
   procedure showhint(const sender: twidget; const hint: msestring;
              const apos: pointty;
              const ashowtime: integer = defaulthintshowtime; //0 -> inifinite,
                 // -1 defaultshowtime if ow_timedhint in sender.optionswidget
              const aflags: hintflagsty = defaulthintflags
                      ); overload;

   // shows the hint fully defined in "info" for the widget "sender"
   procedure showhint(const sender: twidget; const info: hintinfoty); overload;

   // removes the current hint widget & frees its resources & stops its stop timer
   procedure hidehint;

   // restarts the current hint and its stop timer
   procedure restarthint(const sender: twidget);

   function hintedwidget: twidget; //last hinted widget
   function activehintedwidget: twidget; //nil if no hint active

   // returns helpcontext of active widget, '' if none;   
   function activehelpcontext: msestring;

   // returns helpcontext of the widget under mouse, '' if none;
   function mousehelpcontext: msestring;

   // TRUE if one of the app's window/console is in input focus
   function active: boolean;

   // returns the desktop resolution ( or the virtual one if used )
   function screensize: sizety;

   // returns the (virtual) desktop resolution except the tray area,
   // nil -> current active window
   function workarea(const awindow: twindow = nil): rectty;

   // returns which application window ( a form not an eventwidget, an openglwidget or a windowwidget !) 
   // is active ( provides the input focus ),
   // it's same for all widgets of the form served by this window
   function activewindow: twindow;

/ * A transient window is a descendant of ( "transientfor" ) another window in the stacking order hierarchy */

   // returns a first non-transient ( on top of the app stacking order ) window upward 
   // from the currently active window of the application.
   // or that active window if no such
   function regularactivewindow: twindow;

   // same as "activewindow" but the window must not be released (?)
   function unreleasedactivewindow: twindow;

   // returns the focused widget of the currently active window if one exists
   function activewidget: twidget;

   // returns the widget presenteing the currently active window
   function activerootwidget: twidget;
   
   // returns the window ( not hidden or disabled !) under the screen point "pos"
   function windowatpos(const pos: pointty): twindow;

   // puts to "awidget" the container of widget pointed by "namepath"
   // ( finalizing "." is discarded if found ) ,
   // FALSE if not found, and NIL and TRUE if "namepath" = ''
   function findwidget(const namepath: string; out awidget: twidget): boolean;

   // rebuilds the application's window list accorrding to the current on-screen Z-order of its windows;
   // window list is ordered by "z" - bottom first & top last;
   // invisibles first
   procedure sortzorder;

   // returns a copy of the internal window list of application
   function windowar: windowarty;

   // returns the list of application window winIDs
   function winidar: winidarty;

   // returns the count of the application windows    
   function windowcount: integer;

   // returns the window by its number ( "index" >= 0) in the application window list
   property windows[const index: integer]: twindow read getwindows;

   // returns the lowest visible window in stackorder, 
   // calls "sortzorder" within
   function bottomwindow: twindow;

   // returns the highest visible window in stackorder, 
   // calls "sortzorder" within
   function topwindow: twindow;


   // TRUE if all owned windows pass "CanClose" check or 
   // don't have focused widgets
   function candefocus: boolean;

   // subscribes the handler "method" to receive keyboard events
   procedure registeronkeypress(const method: keyeventty);

   // unsubscribes the handler "method" from receiving keyboard events
   procedure unregisteronkeypress(const method: keyeventty);

   // subscribes the handler "method" to receive shortcut events
   procedure registeronshortcut(const method: keyeventty);

   // unsubscribes the handler "method" from receiving shortcut events
   procedure unregisteronshortcut(const method: keyeventty);

   // subscribes the handler "method" to receive "OnWindowActiveChanged" event ( form-wide )
   procedure registeronactivechanged(const method: activechangeeventty);

   // unsubscribes the handler "method" from receiving "OnWindowActiveChanged" event ( form-wide )
   procedure unregisteronactivechanged(const method: activechangeeventty);

   // subscribes the handler "method" to receive "OnDestroyed" events ( form-wide )
   procedure registeronwindowdestroyed(const method: windoweventty);

   // unsubscribes the handler "method" from receiving "OnDestroyed" events ( form-wide )
   procedure unregisteronwindowdestroyed(const method: windoweventty);

   // subscribes the handler "method" to receive "OnWindowDestroyed" events ( form-wide )
   procedure registeronwiniddestroyed(const method: winideventty);

   // unsubscribes the handler "method" form receiving "OnWindowDestroyed" events ( form-wide )
   procedure unregisteronwiniddestroyed(const method: winideventty);

   // subscribes the handler "method" to receive "ApplicationActiveChanged" events ( form-wide )
   procedure registeronapplicationactivechanged(const method: booleaneventty);

   // unsubscribes the handler "method" from receiving "ApplicationActiveChanged" events ( form-wide )
   procedure unregisteronapplicationactivechanged(const method: booleaneventty);

// tcustomapplication

   // subscribes the handler "method" to receive "OnTerminated" event ( form-wide )
   procedure registeronterminated(const method: notifyeventty);

   // unsubscribes the handler "method" from receiving "OnTerminated" events ( form-wide )
   procedure unregisteronterminated(const method: notifyeventty);

   // subscribes the handler "method" to receive "OnTerminateQuery" event ( form-wide )
   procedure registeronterminate(const method: terminatequeryeventty);

   // unsubscribes the handler "method" from receiving "OnTerminateQuery" event ( form-wide )
   procedure unregisteronterminate(const method: terminatequeryeventty);

   // subscribes the handler "method" to receive "OnIdle" event ( form-wide )
   procedure registeronidle(const method: idleeventty);

   // unsubscribes the handler "method" from receiving "OnIdle" events ( form-wide )
   procedure unregisteronidle(const method: idleeventty);

   // calls "canclose" of all application windows except the "sender" window 
   // if all "canclose"are TRUE then checks "OnTerminateQuery" 
   // for all its subscribers ( usually forms of the application )
   procedure terminate(const sender: twindow = nil); 

   // TRUE as long as a "terminate" call is in progress
   function terminating: boolean;

   // TRUE as long as a "deinitialize" call is in progress
   function deinitializing: boolean;
   
   // returns the current caret object ( the text input focus indicator ) of the application
   / ( this object provides facilities to control position & appearance & visibility & timings of the caret )
   property caret: tcaret read fcaret;

   // returns the current mouse object of the application
   / ( this object provides facitities to control position & appearance of the mouse )   
   property mouse: tmouse read fmouse;

   // simulates mouseparkevent 
   // ( an adjusting mouse movement without user intervention - grid snapping, docking etc ?)
   procedure mouseparkevent;

   // sets mouse position correction for further mouse events,
   // the real position is less the visual one by the supplied shift
   procedure delayedmouseshift(const ashift: pointty);

   // returns/sets a cursor shape used for widgets having their cursor shape set to "cr_default";
   // setting it to "cr_default" restores the individual widget cursor(s)
   property widgetcursorshape: cursorshapety read fwidgetcursorshape write
                                        fwidgetcursorshape;

   // returns/sets the current application-wide cursor shape ( not "watches" if a waiting dialog is currently displayed ! )
   // or request to set a new cursor shape ( app-wide );
   // doesn't change when changing mouse widgets
   // 
   // if called from a non-main app thread & no waiting dialogue displayed then redraws 
   // the cursor immediately;
   // set it to "cr_default" to restore the shape to one set by "widgetcursorshape"
   //
   property cursorshape: cursorshapety; // cr_arrow, cr_*

   // assures the displayed mouse cursor shape to be the shape assigned to the currently under-mouse widget,
   // otherwise "cr_default" 
   procedure updatecursorshape; //restores cursorshape of mousewidget

   // returns a widget of the application where the mouse is currently positioned over
   property mousewidget: twidget read fmousewidget;

   // returns a widget of the application currently "owning" the mouse ( grabbing all mouse input )
   property mousecapturewidget: twidget read fmousecapturewidget;


   // returns/sets a window to become the main window of the application
   // then resets all other application windows to the window group it belongs to ( Linux only );
   //
   // the main window minimizes all windows if minimized;
   property mainwindow: twindow read fmainwindow write setmainwindow;

   // returns which system thread was allocated to the application on its start
   // ( the main thread )
   property thread: threadty read fthread;

   // returns teh widget where a mouse button click occured last time 
   // ( to compare with when determinibg whether another widget is clicked )
   property buttonpresswidgetbefore: twidget read fbuttonpresswidgetbefore;

   // returns teh widget where a mouse button release occured last time 
   // ( to compare with when determinibg whether another widget is clicked )
   property buttonreleasewidgetbefore: twidget read fbuttonreleasewidgetbefore;


   // returns/sets the interval of mouse double click recognition ( in microsecs ),
   // defaults to 0.4 sec
   property dblclicktime: integer read fdblclicktime write fdblclicktime default
                 defaultdblclicktime; //us

// tcustomapplication

   // creates a datamodule instance ( its startup code including "OnLoaded" is executed )
   procedure createdatamodule(instanceclass: msecomponentclassty; var reference);


   // enters the application event loop;
   //
   // once the loop finishes, performs "OnTerminated" for all its subscribers,
   // destroys all application forms ( components & windows )
   procedure run;

   // TRUE if the eventloop is entered
   function running: boolean;

   // returns/sets the application name 
   // ( defaults to the full path to application executable in the native OS format );
   // currently, only for informatiion query purposes
   property applicationname: msestring read fapplicationname write fapplicationname;
   

   // if exclusive "rights" are satisfied for the main thread ( a mutex lock is OK )  & the event loop is in progress 
   // then posts the "event" to the main application thread for asyc processing,
   // otherwise adds the event to the internal list for further handling as soon as the above conditions meet
   procedure postevent(event: tevent);

   // TRUE if never idle since last call,
   // unlocks the application and calls sleep if not mainthread and asleepus >= 0
   function checkoverload(const asleepus: integer = 100000): boolean;

   // returns/sets the application exception handler
   property onexception: exceptioneventty read fonexception write fonexception;

   // if not "eabort" & no unhandled exceptions, 
   // executes the above "OnException" code if assigned 
   // or shows an exception message otherwise;
   procedure handleexception(sender: tobject = nil; 
                                       const leadingtext: string = '');

   // synchronizes the calling thread with the main event loop ( via a mutex),
   // TRUE if the calling thread allready holds the mutex,
   // the mutex is recursive
   function lock: boolean;

   // tries to synchronize the calling thread with the main event loop ( via a mutex)
   function trylock: boolean;

   // releases the mutex if the calling thread holds the mutex,
   // TRUE if no unlock done
   function unlock: boolean;

   // releases the mutex recursively if the calling thread holds the mutex,
   // returns "count" for the below "relockall"
   function unlockall: integer;

   // regains the mutex to serve "count" locks
   procedure relockall(count: integer);

   // creates a syncronize event ( which will fire asyncronously then waits for another thread will allow it to finish ), assigns "proc" to it as the event handler, 
   // then frees all locks temporarily then posts the event to the app event queue & waits fot it to be processed the resores the locks;
   // 
   // TRUE if not aborted, quiet -> shows no exceptions if occurs
   //
   // the "syncronize event" is an event owning a semaphore which can be touched by another thread 
   // thus causing "event.waitfo" to return & to exec the event handler code
   //
   function synchronize(const proc: objectprocty;
                       const quite: boolean = false): boolean;

   // TRUE if the calling ( this function ) thread is the application main thread
   function ismainthread: boolean;

   // TRUE if the currently locked thread is the application main thread
   function islockthread: boolean;

   // waith for "athread" to terminate,
   // does "unlock-relock" around waiting
   procedure waitforthread(athread: tmsethread);

   // post a "nothing-to-do" event for asynchronous processing in the main thread 
   procedure wakeupmainthread;

   // invalidates all registered forms of the application so that their widgets redraw land-specific captions 
   // ( changed by "mseconsts.setlangconsts" ),
   // called internally in "setlangconsts" before return
   procedure langchanged; virtual;

   // returns/sets "aps_terminated" state flag ( no actions ? )
   // this flag is also set internally by "terminate" if not cancelled
   property terminated: boolean read getterminated write setterminated;

   // returns the number of "handleexception" calls having an effect ( a message or the handler code )
   property exceptioncount: longword read fexceptioncount;


private
 // function tinternalapplication.beginmodal(const sender: twindow): boolean;

DB

DBedit

DBfields

TDBwidgetgrid

  Properties:

        anchors - ...
	bounds - ...

	color 
		- color of the grid's client area
	cursor 
		- cursor shape when the mouse is over the client area

	datacols
		colorselect
		linecolor
		linecolorfix
		linewidth
		newrowcol

		options
			co_readonly
			co_nofocus
			co_invisible
			co_disabled
			co_drawfocus
			co_mousemovefocus
			co_lefbuttonfocusonly
			co_focusselect
			co_mouseselect
			co_keyselect
			co_multiselect
			co_resetselectionexit
			co_rowselect
			co_fixwidth
			co_fixpos
			co_fill
			co_proportional
			co_nohscroll
			co_savevalue
			co_savestate
			co_rowfont
			co_rowcolor
			co_zebracolor
			co_nosort
			co_sortdescent
			co_norearrange
			co_cancopy
			co_canpaste
			co_mousescrollrow
			co_rowdatachange

		sortcol
		width

		items[N]
			color
			colorselect
			datalist - ???
			face - see <any face>
			fontselect - see <any font>
			frame - see <any frame>
			linecolor
			linecolorfix
			linewidth
			name
			
			options
	

Report

TRepSpacer

TRecordBand

TrepValueDisp

TRepPageNumdisp

TRepPrintDateDisp

TBandGroup

TTileArea

Design

TGdbMi

TSyntaxEdit

TSyntaxPainter

Comm

TCommPort

TAsciiCommPort

TAsciiProtPort

TCommSelector

General stuff

Properties for all widgets


	name

	anchors

		-----------

		- they control of design/runtime sticking widgets to their parents

		- dimention pair ( top/bottom or left/right ) both set to "false" cause 
		the widget to fit the parent's client area in that dimention;
		this effect may be partial in case of "bounds_c*max" settings limit the extents

		*** Return to the look "before dimention fit" is only possible by manual resizing or setting "bounds_*"
		-----------
		an_left 
			- on run-time, resizes/shifts left the widget to keep the design-set distance 
			between the widget's left border and the left side of parent's client area 
			as the parent resizes, until scrolling begins

		an_top
			- on run-time, resizes/shifts up the widget to keep the design-set distance 
			between the widget's top border and the upper side of parent's client area 
			as the parent resizes, until scrolling begins

		an_right
			- on run-time, resizes/shifts right the widget to keep the design-set distance 
			between the widget's right border and the right side of parent's client area 
			as the parent resizes, until scrolling begins

		an_bottom
			- on run-time, resizes/shifts down the widget to keep the design-set distance 
			between the widget's bottom border and the lower side of parent's client area 
			as the parent resizes, until scrolling begins

	bounds

		cx	- width of the widget
		cxmax, cxmin - design/runtime width of the widget is enforced between "cxmax" and "cxmin"
		cy	- height of the widget
		cymax, cymin - design/runtime height of the widget is enforced between "cymax" and "cymin"
		x	- distance between the widget's left border and the left side of parent's client area 
		y	- distance between the widget's top border and the upper side of parent's client area 


	autosize

		-----------
		- only applicable to widgets with "ow_autosize" set
		- the effect may be partial in case when "bounds_c*max" settings limit the extents
		-----------

		cx - addition to width of the widget (with h-centering post applied)
		cy - addition to height of the widget (with v-centering post applied)

	- color
		= the default color of client area & caption text background
		= may be overwritten:
			* the client area - with "frame.colorclient"
			* the caption BG - with "frame.font.colorbackground"

	- font
		= see {any font}

	- frame
		= see {any frame}

	- face
		= see {any face}

	- hint
		= descriptive text appearing when mouse pointer enters the widget

	- cursor
		= shape of the mouse pointer over the client area of widget (run-time only)

	- visible
		= "true" allow the widget to appear ( run-time only )

	- enabled
		= "true" allows the widget to participate in GUI interaction
		= "false" disallows the widget & its children :
			* processing all events & shortcuts & menu calls
			* auto "CanClose" check

			Also "false" usually paints the widget in color marking 
			the "disabled" state ( usually light gray font color )

	- popupmenu
		= reference to a preset tpopupmenu widget serving the right-click menu

	- taborder
		- {0..N} order number when TAB-key cycling through widgets in the container 

	- tag
		- an integer value bound to this widget instance

	- helpcontext
		= a string returned by "(active/mouse)helpcontext" methods of the owning form 
		  when this widget is focused or under mouse in the active window

	- zorder
		= reading: finds the current Z-order of the widget's window
		= setting: if the value = 0 then lowers the widget's window in the stacking hierarchy, otherwise rises


	optionswidget:

		ow_background
			- keeps the window/widget on bottom of the Z-order stack.

		ow_top
			- keeps the window/widget in foreground

		ow_noautosizing
			- when docking, not to resize for the docking area

		ow_mousefocus
			- "false" here disables focusing the widget with mouse
			  ( and "OnFocus" doesn't fire on mouse clicks )

		ow_tabfocus
			- "false" here disables focusing the widget with "TAB" key
			  ( and "OnFocus" doesn't fire on TAB pressed )

		ow_parenttabfocus
			- enters the childs on TAB-focusing then returns to the widget after 
			sequential TAB-ing through its child widgets,
			otherwise TAB-ing cycles on the children if entered

		ow_arrowfocus
			- allows the widget ( and its children in turn ) to be focused with 
			the arrow keys 

		ow_subfocus, ow_arrowfocusin, ow_arrowfocusout
			- in case of arrow keys focusing enabled for child-containing widget, 
			determine behaviour on entering & leaving the widget, see the below table:

			ow_subfocus	| ow_arrowfocusin |	ow_arrowfocusout | effect

			   FALSE           FALSE             FALSE         entering-/leaving-
			   FALSE           FALSE             TRUE          entering-/leaving+
			   FALSE           TRUE              FALSE         entering(nearest)+/leaving-
			   FALSE           TRUE              TRUE          entering(nearest)+/leaving+
			   TRUE            FALSE             FALSE         entering(last focused)+/leaving-
			   TRUE            FALSE             TRUE          entering(last focused)+/leaving+
			   TRUE            TRUE              FALSE         entering(nearest)+/leaving-
			   TRUE            TRUE              TRUE          entering(nearest)+/leaving+

			- "entering" is focusing on a child within the widget
			- "leaving"  is return from last child onto the widget's level
			- "nearest" is the child closest on the arrow direction
			- "last focused" is the child focused on last leaving the widget
 
			*** The Up/Down arrow keys can leave from the children circle, 
				but Left/Right can only toggle between the children ***

			*** mouse entering/leaving isn't controllable by these options


		ow_focusbackonesc 
			- on pressing "Esc", returns input focus to the previously focused widget

		ow_noparentshortcut

			*** disables processing of delegated ( from the parent ) shortcuts *** 

			- "true" here disables processing shortcuts	if they're delegated 
			from the parent widget ( obviously, not processed by the parent )

		ow_nochildshortcut

			*** disables delegating shortcuts to the parent for taking decision *** 

			- if "true" then the widget tries to process it by oneself 
			otherwise it's passed to the parent widget for further chaining

			*** A shortcut can only be processed once ( by one widget ) ***

		ow_canclosenil
			- "true" here allows to continue even if there's contained widget(s) 
			not passing "CanClose" check

		ow_mousetransparent
			- "true" here causes the widget oneself ( not its contained ones ) 
			not to react to mouse events ( just allow them through to the children )

		ow_mousewheel
			- enables/disables {scrolling/navigating} with wheel of ImPS/2 etc mouse

		ow_noscroll
			- don't use screen image scrolling for twidget.scrollrect, 
			redraw the whole scrolled widget rectangle instead;
			sometimes needed with background fades.

		ow_nochildpaintclip
			- 

		ow_destroywidgets
			- "true" here causes calling "free" for all containing widgets as well

		ow_hinton
			- to show the hint even in case of hinting is disabled on the parent
			( "parent.ow_hintoff= true & parent.ow_hinton= false" )

		ow_hintoff 
			- "true" here combined with "ow_hinton=false" fully disables displaying the hint

		ow_multiplehint 
			- "true" here causes the widget to redisplay its hint on each {>3px} move within the widget oneself

        	ow_timedhint 
			- "true" here causes hint of the widget to disappear after a timed inteval (about 2 secs by default)

		ow_fontlineheight (design-time only)
			- causes "extraspace" of the last text line to be drawn, 
			in turn it causes adjustment of widget height if "ow_autoscale" is set
			
			*** makes sence only if "ow_autoscale=true" & ow_autosize=false & "extraspace <> 0" ***

		ow_fontglyphheight (design-time only)
			- causes only interline "extraspace"-s to be drawn, opposite to "ow_fontlineheight" 

		ow_autoscale (design-time only)
			- causes that if the contents change (design OR run-time) so that its' height changes 
			then the widget will be v-scaled as well

		ow_autosize (design-time only)
			- causes that widget's height & width & client area adjust so that to provide space for contents of the client area
			- no design-time change of height/width are possible as long as this option is in effect

		ow_autosizeanright
			- when autosizing & {an_right isn't set}, the design-set right margin against the parent is preserved

		ow_autosizeanbottom
			- when autosizing & {an_bottom isn't set}, the design-set bottom margin against the parent is preserved

	optionsskin:

		- osc_noskin
		- osc_framebuttononly
		- osc_container


	Methods:

	  // tmsecomponent

		// (re)draws the widget according to the related skin if apllicable;
		//
		// also called internally by "loaded" procedure ( before "OnLoaded" code ),
		// by ShowMessage ( for the internal widgets of the message dialogue ), 
		// when creating tab & form & menu widgets
		procedure updateskin(const recursive: boolean = false);

		// TRUE if the instance is created but not yet ready 
		// for interaction & accessing data & appearance change & receiving events etc
		// ( the stage between firing "OnCreate" & "OnLoaded" )
		function loading: boolean;
	
	 {$ifdef FPC}
		procedure setinline(value: boolean); // ?
		procedure setancestor(value: boolean); // ?
	 {$endif}

		// TRUE if all conditios are OK for executing the code of "event" ( a handler must be assigned to the event )
		function canevent(const event: tmethod): boolean;


		// Shortly, replaces the persistent storage of the widget
		//
		// if {value <> nil} then 
		//	- if "instance" is nil then calls "createproc" to create the instance,
		//    then assigns the instance's value:= "value" 
		// otherwise frees "instance"
		procedure setoptionalobject(const value: tpersistent; var instance;
                        createproc: createprocty);

		// creates the persistent storage of the widget via calling "createproc"
		procedure getoptionalobject(const instance: tobject; createproc: createprocty);

		// obtains & puts to "obj" a CORBA interface entry for "aintf" (GUID,...)
		function getcorbainterface(const aintf: ptypeinfo; out obj) : boolean;

        // TRUE if the widget is owned, or "self" otherwise
		function checkowned(component: tcomponent): boolean; 

        // TRUE if the widget is owner, or "self" otherwise
		function checkowner(component: tcomponent): boolean; 

		// return the top-most widget in owner chain starting from this widget
		function rootowner: tcomponent;

		// return the array of owning widgets starting from this widget
		// componentarty[0] is the widget oneself
		function getrootcomponentpath: componentarty;

        // returns items of objeclinker ( which notify this widget )
        // and free notify list ( which are notified by this widget ),
        // duplicates are removed.
        //	
        // Notifies mainly relate to insertion/removal operation on widgets
        // The notify list is maintained by FreeNotification & RemoveFreeNotification
		function linkedobjects: objectarty;

		// sends "event" recursively to child widgets until no more children or 
		// the event is processed ( cea_processed ) by one of the children,
		// "event" will be destroyed if destroyevent= true and not async
		procedure sendcomponentevent(const event: tcomponentevent; 
                                        const destroyevent: boolean = true);

		// sends "event" to each of owning widgets downward from the root owner,
		// "event" will be destroyed if destroyevent= true and not async
		procedure sendrootcomponentevent(const event: tcomponentevent;
                                        const destroyevent: boolean = true);

		// posts an async "atag"-ged event to be handled by oneself
		procedure asyncevent(atag: integer = 0);

		// posts a "tcomponentevent" instance from sender=self, 
		// "kind" is defined when creating the event, 
		// and "tag" may be adjusted after creation
		procedure postcomponentevent(const event: tcomponentevent);

		// returns the classname of the widget if the widget is toplevel, 
		// and "tmsecomponent" otherwise )
		property moduleclassname: string read getmoduleclassname;

		// returns the classname of the widget as the entry of its constructor
		// ( button => tbutton, datamodule => tdm1mo, form => ttstfo, dbstringedit => tdbstringedit,.. )
		property actualclassname: string read getactualclassname;

		// returns "fmsecomponentstate"
		// ( a set of cs_ismodule,cs_endreadproc,cs_loadedproc,cs_noload, cs_hasskin,cs_noskin )
		property msecomponentstate: msecomponentstatesty read fmsecomponentstate;

		// returns/sets a pointer associated with the widget
		// ( contrary to the integer "tag", allows to use an arbitary data type 
		// for associating data )
		property tagpo: pointer read ftagpo write ftagpo;

		// returns/sets a string identifying the widget in the help system
		property helpcontext: msestring read gethelpcontext write fhelpcontext;

	// twidget

		// creates an instance of the widget, owned by "aowner" if not NIL
		constructor create(aowner: tcomponent); override;

		destructor destroy; override;

		// ??
		procedure afterconstruction; override;

		// rescales the widget frame ( if assigned ) then owned widgets ( if exist, recursively ) then bounds_* then the font ( if assigned )
		// called before inserting in parentwidget,
		// calls "scale(ascale)",
		// no visual repainting
		procedure initnewcomponent(const ascale: real); virtual;

 		// restores the "fontheight" to "font.glyphheight" if "ow_fontglyphheight" or
 		// to "font.lineheight" if "ow_fontlineheight" otherwise,
		// ascale is ignored ?
		// calls "synctofontheight->setfontheight",
		// called after inserting in parentwidget,
		// no visual repainting
		procedure initnewwidget(const ascale: real); virtual;

		// creates the widget frame if not yet created
		procedure createframe;

		// creates the widget face if not yet  created
		procedure createface;

		// creates the widget font if not yet  created
		procedure createfont;

		// checks ws_loadlock and csdestroing too
		function isloading: boolean;

		// returns "widgetstatety" - a set of (
		// ws_visible,ws_enabled,ws_active,ws_entered,ws_entering,ws_exiting,
		// ws_focused,ws_mouseinclient,ws_wantmousebutton,ws_wantmousemove,
		// ws_wantmousefocus,ws_iswidget,ws_opaque,ws_nopaint,
		// ws_clicked,ws_mousecaptured,ws_clientmousecaptured,
		// ws_loadlock,ws_loadedproc,ws_showproc,ws_minclientsizevalid,
		// ws_showed,ws_hidden, //used in tcustomeventwidget
		// ws_destroying,ws_staticframe,ws_staticface,ws_isvisible
		//
		// iframe
		function widgetstate: widgetstatesty;

		// returns "widgetstate1ty" - a set of (
		// (ws1_childscaled,ws1_fontheightlock,
		// ws1_widgetregionvalid,ws1_rootvalid,
		// ws1_anchorsizing,ws1_isstreamed,
		// ws1_scaled, //used in tcustomscalingwidget
		// ws1_noclipchildren,
		// ws1_nodesignvisible,ws1_nodesignframe,ws1_nodesignhandles,
		// ws1_nodesigndelete,ws1_designactive,
		// ws1_fakevisible,ws1_nominsize //used for report size calculations
		// )
		property widgetstate1: widgetstates1ty read fwidgetstate1;
		
			* this set of states is needed because the max FPC set size is 32 
			  thus "widgetstate1ty" can't fit all states

		// TRUE if the widget is contained within another widget
		// ( tcomponent stuff )
		function hasparent: boolean; override;               

		// returns the parent component if it's a widget or the grandparent otherwise
		function getparentcomponent: tcomponent; override;   // tcomponent

		// TRUE if "awidget" is an ascendant or the widget or they are the same widget
		function checkdescendent(awidget: twidget): boolean;
		
		// TRUE if app is running and the widget owns the caret or the caret widget
		function hascaret: boolean;

        // TRUE if "winid" allocated and not loading and not destroying,
        // all widgets on a form have "winid" of this form ( a real window allocated by the OS )
        // thus have this function TRUE
		function windowallocated: boolean;

		// TRUE if presents a valid toplevelwindow with assigned "winid"
		function ownswindow: boolean;

		// invalidated area of the widget, the origin is "clientpos" against the roor widget
		function updaterect: rectty; 

		// calls recursively "canclose" for all contained widgets ( the widget oneself excluded! ),
		// TRUE if none of the widgets return FALSE
		//
		// more specialized widgets may have "canclose" overridden 
		// to perform more work than just this call recursion
		// ( not null or range check,.. )
		//
		// "onclosequery" must also pass the check if assigned, for the function to succeed
		function canclose(const newfocus: twidget = nil): boolean; virtual;

        // checks "canclose" first for focused widget of the window ( form,.. ) 
        // if it is a descendant of the widget or the widget oneself,
        // then continues with subwidgets of the widget;
        // also - finishes editing ( snapshots "value" ) in the focused widget before checking
		function canparentclose(const newfocus: twidget): boolean; overload;

		// the above function but with the preserved focus
		function canparentclose: boolean; overload;
                   //newfocus = window.focusedwidget      

		function canfocus: boolean; virtual;
		function setfocus(aactivate: boolean = true): boolean; virtual;//true if ok
		procedure nextfocus; //sets inputfocus to then next appropriate widget

		function findtabfocus(const ataborder: integer): twidget;
                       //nil if cannot focus

		function firsttabfocus: twidget;
		function lasttabfocus: twidget;
		function nexttaborder(const down: boolean = false): twidget;

		function focusback(const aactivate: boolean = true): boolean;
                               //false if focus not changed

		function parentcolor: colorty;
		function actualcolor: colorty; virtual;
		function actualopaquecolor: colorty;
		function backgroundcolor: colorty;
		function translatecolor(const acolor: colorty): colorty;

		procedure widgetevent(const event: twidgetevent); virtual;

		procedure sendwidgetevent(const event: twidgetevent);
                              //event will be destroyed

		procedure release; override;

		function show(const modal: boolean = false; const transientfor: twindow = nil): modalresultty; virtual;

		procedure hide;
		procedure activate(const abringtofront: boolean = true); virtual;
                             //show and setfocus

		procedure bringtofront;
		procedure sendtoback;
		procedure stackunder(const predecessor: twidget);

		procedure paint(const canvas: tcanvas); virtual;
		procedure update; virtual;
		procedure scrollwidgets(const dist: pointty);

		procedure scrollrect(const dist: pointty; const rect: rectty; scrollcaret: boolean);
                             //origin = paintrect.pos

		procedure scroll(const dist: pointty);
                            //scrolls paintrect and widgets

		procedure getcaret;
		procedure scrollcaret(const dist: pointty);
		function mousecaptured: boolean;
		procedure capturemouse(grab: boolean = true);
		procedure releasemouse;
		procedure capturekeyboard;
		procedure releasekeyboard;
		procedure synctofontheight; virtual;

		procedure dragevent(var info: draginfoty); virtual;
		procedure dochildscaled(const sender: twidget); virtual;

		procedure invalidatewidget;     //invalidates whole widget
		procedure invalidate;           //invalidates clientrect
		procedure invalidaterect(const rect: rectty; org: originty = org_client);
		procedure invalidateframestate;

		procedure invalidateframestaterect(const rect: rectty; 
                                        const org: originty = org_client);   
		function hasoverlappingsiblings(arect: rectty): boolean; //origin = pos

		function window: twindow;
		function rootwidget: twidget;

		function parentofcontainer: twidget;
            //parentwidget.parentwidget if parentwidget has not ws_iswidget,
            //parentwidget otherwise

		property parentwidget: twidget read fparentwidget write setparentwidget;
		function getrootwidgetpath: widgetarty; //root widget is last

		// number of contained widgets ( the widget oneself excluded ! )
		function widgetcount: integer;

		function parentwidgetindex: integer; //index in parentwidget.widgets, -1 if none
		property widgets[const index: integer]: twidget read getwidgets;
		function widgetatpos(var info: widgetatposinfoty): twidget; overload;
		function widgetatpos(const pos: pointty): twidget; overload;

		function widgetatpos(const pos: pointty; 
                   const state: widgetstatesty): twidget; overload;

		property taborderedwidgets: widgetarty read gettaborderedwidgets;

		function findtagwidget(const atag: integer; const aclass: widgetclassty): twidget;
              //returns first matching descendent

		property container: twidget read getcontainer;
		function containeroffset: pointty;
		function childrencount: integer; virtual;
		property children[const index: integer]: twidget read getchildwidgets; default;

		function childatpos(const pos: pointty; 
                   const clientorigin: boolean = true): twidget; virtual;

		function getsortxchildren: widgetarty;
		function getsortychildren: widgetarty;
		property focusedchild: twidget read ffocusedchild;
		property focusedchildbefore: twidget read ffocusedchildbefore;

		function mouseeventwidget(const info: mouseeventinfoty): twidget;

		function checkdescendent(widget: twidget): boolean;
                    //true if widget is descendent or self

		function checkancestor(widget: twidget): boolean;
                    //true if widget is ancestor or self

		function containswidget(awidget: twidget): boolean;

		procedure insertwidget(const awidget: twidget); overload;

		procedure insertwidget(const awidget: twidget; const apos: pointty); overload; virtual;
                 //widget can be child

		function iswidgetclick(const info: mouseeventinfoty; const caption: boolean = false): boolean;
		//true if eventtype = et_butonrelease, button is mb_left, clicked and pos in clientrect
 		//or in frame.caption if caption = true, origin = pos

		function isclick(const info: mouseeventinfoty): boolean;
		//true if eventtype = et_butonrelease, button is mb_left, clicked and pos in clientrect

		function isdblclick(const info: mouseeventinfoty): boolean;
		//true if eventtype = et_butonpress, button is mb_left, pos in clientrect
		// and timedlay to last buttonpress is short

		function isdblclicked(const info: mouseeventinfoty): boolean;
		//true if eventtype in [et_buttonpress,et_butonrelease], button is mb_left,
		// and timedlay to last same buttonevent is short

		function isleftbuttondown(const info: mouseeventinfoty): boolean;
		//true if eventtype = et_butonpress, button is mb_left, pos in clientrect
		//origin = paintrect.pos

		widgetrect: the widget on-screen area including its frame & frame caption

			paintrect: the widget on-screen area except its frame & frame caption

			clientrect: virtual area which 
				- for non-scrolling widgets, equals to "paintrect", with its "pos:= (0,0)"
				- for scrolling widgets, may be bigger than "paintrect", 
				  also may shift ( change its "pos" ) when scrolling
		
	// the coord of outer top-left corner against the toplevel form = the window owner,
	// including the frame & frame caption 
		function rootpos: pointty; 

	// the coord of the outer top-left corner against the screen ( the WM decorations aren't counted in )
	// includes the frame & frame caption 
		property screenpos: pointty; 

	//  the coord of the outer top-left corner against the parent widget,
	// including the frame & frame caption 
		property widgetrect: rectty; 
		property pos: pointty; // =widgetrect.pos
		property size: sizety; // =widgetrect.size
		property left: integer; // =bounds_x
		property right: integer; //widgetrect.x + widgetrect.cx, sets cx;
		property top: integer;  // =bounds_y
		property bottom: integer; //widgetrect.y + widgetrect.cy, sets cy;
		property width: integer; // =bounds_cx
		property height: integer; // =bounds_cy
		function widgetsizerect: rectty;          //pos = nullpoint

    // the coord of the paint area ( paintrect ) against own outer top-left corner ( against "widgetrect=pos" )
    //  except the frame & frame caption 
		function paintrect: rectty;
		function paintpos: pointty;
		function paintsize: sizety;
		function innerpaintrect: rectty; // mainly equals to paintrect
		function clientwidgetrect: rectty; // mainly equals to paintrect
		function clientwidgetpos: pointty;
		function clippedpaintrect: rectty; // mainly equals to  but clipped by all parentpaintrects
		function innerwidgetrect: rectty;     // mainly equals to paintrect
		function innerclientwidgetpos: pointty;

    // the coord of the paint area ( paintrect ) against own outer top-left corner ( against "widgetrect=pos" )
    //  except the frame caption 
		function framerect: rectty; // =paintrect except the frame caption area
		function framepos: pointty;
		function framesize: sizety;

    // the coord of the client area ( clientrect )  against the paint area ( paintrect )
    //  usually these areas match
		function clientrect: rectty;
		property clientsize: sizety;
		property clientwidth: integer;
		property clientheight: integer;
		property clientpos: pointty;

    // the coord of the paint area of the parent against the paint area of this widget
		function paintrectparent: rectty; //nullrect if parent = nil,

    // the coord of the client area of the parent against the paint area of this widget
		function clientrectparent: rectty; //nullrect if parent = nil,

	// the coord of the inner area against the client area ( clientrect )
		function innerclientrect: rectty;  // mainly equals to clientrect
		function innerclientsize: sizety;
		function innerclientpos: pointty;

		function framewidth: sizety;              //widgetrect.size - paintrect.size
		function clientframewidth: sizety;        //widgetrect.size - clientrect.size
		function innerclientframewidth: sizety;   //widgetrect.size - innerclientrect.size
		function innerframewidth: sizety;         //clientrect.size - innerclientrect.size  

    // the coord of the paint area against the widgetrect(pos) of the parent
		function paintparentpos: pointty;    //origin = parentwidget.pos

    // the coord of the client area against the widgetrect(pos) of the parent
		function clientparentpos: pointty;   //origin = parentwidget.pos

    // the coord of the widgetrect(pos) against the client area of parent
		property parentclientpos: pointty;


		function clientpostowidgetpos(const apos: pointty): pointty;
		function widgetpostoclientpos(const apos: pointty): pointty;
		function widgetpostopaintpos(const apos: pointty): pointty;
		function paintpostowidgetpos(const apos: pointty): pointty;
		procedure scale(const ascale: real); virtual;


		property minsize: sizety read fminsize write setminsize;
		property maxsize: sizety read fmaxsize write setmaxsize;
		function maxclientsize: sizety; virtual;


		property anchors: anchorsty read fanchors write setanchors default defaultanchors;
		property defaultfocuschild: twidget read getdefaultfocuschild write setdefaultfocuschild;


		procedure changeclientsize(const delta: sizety); //asynchronous

		function getcanvas(aorigin: originty = org_client): tcanvas;

		function showing: boolean;
               //true if self and all ancestors visible and window allocated

		function isenabled: boolean;
               //true if self and all ancestors enabled

		function active: boolean;
		function entered: boolean;

		function activeentered: boolean; 
			//true if entered and window is regularactivewindow or inactivated

		function focused: boolean;
		function clicked: boolean;

		function indexofwidget(const awidget: twidget): integer;

		procedure changedirection(const avalue: graphicdirectionty;
                                            var dest: graphicdirectionty); virtual;

		// (re)arranges "awidgets" horizontally within the parent's client area 
		// so that awidget[i] were placed next each other 
		// at h-space dist[i], starting from "startx" with the right margin "endmargin";
		// 
		// if the number of "dist" is fewer than the number of "awidgets" then the remaining h-spaces are taken 
		// as the last "dist[i]" or "0" if none;
		// if the number of "dist" is more than the number of "awidgets" then the extra dist[i] are discarded
		// 
		// non-zero "endmargin" causes one of awdidget[i] to h-resize to provide the margin :
		//  - if one or more of awidgets[i] have [an_left,an_right] set then the first of such is resized
		//    otherwise the last awidgets[i] is h-resized 
		// 
		procedure placexorder(
				const startx: integer; 
				const dist: array of integer;
                const awidgets: array of twidget;
                const endmargin: integer = minint);

		// (re)arranges "awidgets" vertically within the parent's client area 
		// so that awidget[i] were placed upper/lower each other 
		// at v-space dist[i], starting from "starty" with the bottom margin "endmargin";
		// 
		// if the number of "dist" is fewer than the number of "awidgets" then the remaining v-spaces are taken 
		// as the last "dist[i]" or "0" if none;
		// if the number of "dist" is more than the number of "awidgets" then the extra dist[i] are discarded
		// 
		// non-zero "endmargin" causes one of awdidget[i] to v-resize to provide the margin :
		//  - if one or more of awidgets[i] have [an_top,an_bottom] set then the first of such is resized
		//    otherwise the last awidgets[i] is v-resized 
		// 
		procedure placeyorder(
				const starty: integer; 
				const dist: array of integer;
                const awidgets: array of twidget;
                const endmargin: integer = minint);
               //origin = clientpos, endmargin by size adjust of widgets 
               //with [an_top,an_bottom], minint -> no change

		// if {mode <> wam_none} then (re)arranges "awidgets" horizontally  within the parent's client area so that 
		// awidgets[0] stays on its place but awidgets[1..N] :
		// - if {mode = wam_end} then awidgets[i>=1] move or resize ( if "anchors.al_left" set ) so that they right borders match the right border of awidgets[0]
		// - if {mode = wam_start} then awidgets[i>=1] move or resize ( if "anchors.al_right" set ) so that they left borders match the left border of awidgets[0]
		// - if {mode = wam_center} then awidgets[i>=1] move so that they Y-axes match the Y-axe of awidgets[0]
		//
		// mainly applicable for v-stacked widgets since h-stacked may overlap after such alignment
		//
        // returns the reference point ( the coord of awidgets[0] )
		function alignx(const mode: widgetalignmodety;
                        const awidgets: array of twidget): integer;


		// if {mode <> wam_none} then (re)arranges "awidgets" vertically within the parent's client area so that 
		// awidgets[0] stays on its place but awidgets[1..N] : 
		// - if {mode = wam_end} then awidgets[i>=1] move or resize ( if "anchors.al_top" set ) so that they bottom borders match the bottom border of awidgets[0]
		// - if {mode = wam_start} then awidgets[i>=1] move or resize ( if "anchors.al_bottom" set ) so that they top borders match the top border of awidgets[0]
		// - if {mode = wam_center} then awidgets[i>=1] move so that they X-axes match the X-axe of awidgets[0]
		//
		// mainly applicable for h-stacked widgets since v-stacked may overlap after such alignment
		//
        // returns the reference point ( the coord of awidgets[0] )
		function aligny(const mode: widgetalignmodety;
                        const awidgets: array of twidget): integer;

		function actualcursor: cursorshapety; virtual;


	Event handlers:

	- onactivate

		 fires :

		= on receiving input focus, just before "OnFocus"
			
		= forms specific :
			* on 1-st display of the form after "OnLoaded" ( from "Loaded" procedure)
			* on switch back from another apllication/WM ( "oe_activate" event )
			* after closure of a descendant form
			* on minimizing/maximizing the form

	- onchildscaled

		 fires :

		= on child/children resizing due to font height change

		= form widget: once "form.container" {scrolling widget} is loaded

	- ondeactivate
		 fires 
			= form widget: when the form looses input focus
			= non-form widget: when the widget looses input focus

	- ondefocus

		fires 
		= on disabling the widget

	= form widget: if another form is focused
		= non-form widget: if another widget is focused

	- onenter
		= fires on any way of taking parent-wide focus as soon as 
		the parent stores the new child's order, before "OnActivate" & "OnFocus"

	- onexit
		= fires last on parent-wide lossing focus, after "OnDefocus" & "OnDeactivate"
		= for top-level ( not in a container ) forms, doesn't fire

	- onfocus
		fires 
			= once the existing widget takes the focus 
			= on showing the widget's form if the widget has the lowest "TabOrder"

	- onfontheightdelta
		fires
			= if [ow_fontglyphheight OR ow_fontlineheight ] AND {the
			new font height differs from the previos one}
			= before the parent redraws this widget

	- onpopup
		fires :
			= on calling a popup-menu ( with "RightClick" ), once the menu items of the current level are loaded
			( before building the submenus ) 

	- onresize

		= fires on creating/(changing size)/(min-max restoring) of widget, 
		before actual redrawing

		= rechecks if there's real work to do

	- onshowhint
		= fires when a installed hint is activated or on "aplication.showint" called
		= since called last, allows to adjust the default behavior

	- onbeforeupdateskin
		= fires in "updateskin" ( the widget is loaded etc ) before applying the skin

	- onafterupdateskin
		= fires in "updateskin" ( the widget is loaded etc ) once the skin is applied

TWidget stuff

   Properties:    
		- name
		- anchors
		- bounds
		- color
		- enabled
		- visible
		- <face> : see {any face}
		- <frame> : see {any frame}
	    - hint
	    - helpcontext
	    - tag
	    - taborder
	    - cursor
	    - optionswidget
	    - optionsskin
	    - popupmenu
    
		twidget's event handlers:
    
			- on(de)activate
			- onbeforeupdateskin
			- onafterupdateskin
			- onchildscaled
			- onfontheightdelta
			- on(de)focus
			- onenter
			- onmove
			- onpopup
			- onresize
			- onshowhint
      
	align_glue : 
	  ( outer anchoring mode for widget group, in the align mode )
		- wam_none
		- wam_start
		- wan_center
		- wm_end

	align_leader : 
		the widget ( incl another spacer, splitter or layouter ) against which the alignment applies ( the reference widget )

	align_mode : 
	  ( inner anchoring mode within widget group, in the align mode )
		- wam_none
		- wam_start
		- wan_center
		- wm_end

// Place mode:

      
	place_mindist, place_maxdist:
		- in the place(ment) mode, limits distance between widgets
		  ( these distance once calculated also define side margins if applicable )

	place_mode: 
	  ( outer anchoring mode for widget group, in the place mode )
		- wam_none
		- wam_start
		- wan_center
		- wm_end

	place_options:
		- plo_endmargin
			= to resize a widget so that it "eats" extra space if it occurs
			
			* only applicable in the place mode, with a limiting value of "place_maxdist" and:

			  1) {place_mode <> wam_none}
			or
			  2) {place_mode = wam_end} and {plo_propmargin in place_options}

			For the exact look, see above


		- plo_propmargin
			= виджеты расставляются теснее так, чтобы образовались отступы перед и после,
			  причем расстояние между центрами виджетов было бы таким же, 
			  как и растояние между серединами крайних виджетов и соотв. границами зоны расстановки

		- plo_syncmaxautosize
			= see above

		- plo_synccaptiondistx
			= see above

			  * affects widgets with opposite cp_left/right set as well	
			  * the minimal before-adjustment "captiondist" among all widgets limits "captiondist" for each of the widget
              * don't set cfo_captiondistouter here !

		- plo_synccaptiondisty
			= see above

			  * affects also widgets with opposite cp_top/bottom set	
			  * the minimal before-adjustment "captiondist" amongst all widgets limits "captiondist" for each of the widget

              ! here, don't set "cfo_captiondistouter" for affected widgets !

		- plo_syncpaintwidth
			= see above

		- plo_syncpaintheight
			= see above

		- plo_scalesize
			= see above


	dist_left, dist_right, dist_top, dist_bottom : 
		= margins between most outer edge the layouter and 
		  the corresponding linked widget

		* see "tspacer" for detail

	linkleft,linkright,linktop,linkbottom : see "tspacer"

	options:
		- spao_glueright, spao_gluebottom: 
			= set the adjustment dependencies between the layouter and its link_* widgets

			* see "tspacer" for more details

	// which mode of widget placement to apply - see above
	optionslayout: 
		- lao_alignx
		- lao_aligny
		- lao_placex
		- lao_placey
		- lao_scalewidth
		- lao_scaleheight
		- lao_scaleleft
		- lao_scaletop
		
		* lao_place* & lao_align* can't be combined for one direction

	optionsscale: 
	  
	  * cause the layouter to provide full space for the widgets as long as they expand/shrink/move

		- osc_expandx 
			= allocates more h-space if needed

		- osc_shrinkx
			= removes extra h-space if occurred

		- osc_expandy
			= allocates more v-space if needed

		- osc_shrinky
			= removes extra v-space if occurred

		- osc_invisishrinkx
			= fully h-collapses the layouter if "visible=false" ( run-time only )

		- osc_invisishrinky
			= fully v-collapses the layoter if "visible=false" ( run-time only )

	optionsskin:
		= see <any widget>


	Methods:

		constructor create(aowner: tcomponent); override;

Public stuff

	(f)window: 
		the OS-allocated ( root = toplevel ) window common for all widgets of this window
		
		* "widget.fwindow.fowner = widget.self" in case of the widget present the root "fwindow" 
		  ( owns the window )

	(f)rootpos: 
		position of the widget in the coord of toplevel window not the nearest parent widget alone,
		calculated as sum of such positions ( fwidgetrect.pos ) starting from the toplevel through the
                chain of all parents up to the current widget;
		"nullpoint" (0,0) for toplevel widgets ( window-owning forms,..)

	screenpos:
		- coord aginst the top-left corner of screen
		- WM decoration & title aren't parts of the widget !

	widgetrect: 
		the widget on-screen area including its frame & frame caption

	paintrect: 
		the widget on-screen area except its frame & frame caption

	clientrect: 
		virtual area which 
			- for non-scrolling widgets, equals to "paintrect", with its "pos:= (0,0)"
			- for scrolling widgets, may be bigger than "paintrect", 
		 	  also may shift ( change its "pos" ) when scrolling

			* "t*grid" aren't such scrollable widgets since their virtual height would be limited by 
			  the X11 "+-32000" limitation, 
			  so example of such widgets are tscrollbox, "tform.container" etc

	framerect: 
		the widget on-screen area except its frame caption but including inner & outer frame

	****************

	// releases all thread locks then post the event to the app event queue and
	// waits for the event handler finishes ( signalled by "sye_ok on a semaphore )
	// finally restores the locks
    // true if the handler is not aborted
	function synchronizeevent(const aevent: tsynchronizeevent): boolean;

    // translates "point" coord against "source" widgetrect to "dest" widgetrect
	//
	//   * nil "source" = from screen coord 
	//   * nil "dest" = to screen coord
	procedure translatewidgetpoint1(var point: pointty; const source,dest: twidget);

	// the function-framed version of "translatewidgetpoint1"
	function translatewidgetpoint(const point: pointty; const source,dest: twidget): pointty;

	// rect isntead of point, 
	// if dest = nil then to screen 
    // if source = nil then against screen
	function translatewidgetrect(const rect: rectty; const source,dest: twidget): rectty;
	//-----------------
    // translates "point" coord against "source" paintrect to "dest" paintrect
	//   * nil "source" = from screen coord 
	//   * nil "dest" = to screen coord
	procedure translatepaintpoint1(var point: pointty; const source,dest: twidget);

	// the function-framed version of "translatepaintpoint1"
	function translatepaintpoint(const point: pointty; const source,dest: twidget): pointty;

	// rect isntead of point, 
	// if dest = nil then to screen 
    // if source = nil then against screen
	function translatepaintrect(const rect: rectty;const source,dest: twidget): rectty;
    //-----------------
    // translates "point" coord against "source" clientrect to "dest" clienttrect
	//   * nil "source" = from screen coord 
	//   * nil "dest" = to screen coord
	procedure translateclientpoint1(var point: pointty;
                    const source,dest: twidget);

	// the function-framed version of "translateclientpoint1"
	function translateclientpoint(const point: pointty; const source,dest: twidget): pointty;

	// rect isntead of point, 
	// if dest = nil then to screen 
    // if source = nil then against screen
	function translateclientrect(const rect: rectty; const source,dest: twidget): rectty;
    //-----------------

	// (re)sorts "awidgets" in order of increasing their "widgetrect.x" coords
	//   - if parent = nil then the coords are against individual parent of each of "awidgets"
	//   - if parent is supplied then the coords are against this parent
	procedure sortwidgetsxorder(var awidgets: widgetarty; const parent: twidget = nil);

	// (re)sorts "awidgets" in order of increasing their "widgetrect.y" coords
	//   - if parent = nil then the coords are against individual parent of each of "awidgets"
	//   - if parent is supplied then the coords are against this parent
	procedure sortwidgetsyorder(var awidgets: widgetarty; const parent: twidget = nil);

	// for each  of "widgets", calculates its autosized client area ( min size rect to fit the caption, etc )
    //   - both hor & ver sizes of client area of each of "widgets" are adjusted to the max of the above calculated areas,
	//	   as the result - client areas of all widgets become identically v+h sized
    // 
    //   * right & bottom anchored margins of each widget are preserved
	procedure syncmaxautosize(const widgets: array of twidget);

	// for each  of "widgets", width of client area of each of "widgets" is adjusted so that 
    // external ( by the outer border of frame ) widths of all widgets become identical 
    // to the external widht of the widest widget
    //    
    //   * if "awidth" >= 0 then no determining the widest widget is taken and
    //     "awidth" is adjusted to instead, for all widgets
    //   * right anchored margins of each widget are lost
	procedure syncminframewidth(const awidgets: array of twidget;
                               const awidth: integer = -1);

	// for each  of "widgets", height of client area of each of "widgets" is adjusted so that 
    // external ( by the outer border of frame ) heights of all widgets become identical 
    // to the external height of the highest widget
    //    
    //   * if "aheight" >= 0 then no determining the highest widget is taken and
    //     "aheight" is adjusted to instead, for all widgets
    //   * bottom anchored margins of each widget are lost
	procedure syncminframeheight(const awidgets: array of twidget; const aheight: integer = -1);

Projects using MSEgui